You are on page 1of 86

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

RMT-V259/V259B/V259K/V259L/V259R/V259S/V288/V288A/V288B/V288C

SERVICE MANUAL

French Model
SLV-SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/
SX710B/X9B

German Model
SLV-SE710D/SE810D/SX710D/
SX717D/SX810D/X9D

Italian Model
SLV-SE610A

East European Model


Russian Model
SLV-SE610K/SE610N/SE710K/SE710N/
SE810K/SE810N/SX710K/SX710N/X9N

North European Model


SLV-SE610E/SE710E/SE810E/
SX710E/SX717E/X9E

UK Model

Photo: SLV-SE810

SLV-SE610G/SE710G/
SE710I/SE810G/X9G

SR MECHANISM

Refer to the SERVICE MANUAL of VHS MECHANICAL


ADJUSTMENTS VI for MECHANICAL ADJUSTMENTS.
(9-921-647-11)

* The abbreviations of SE610, SE710, SE810, SX710, SX717, SX810 and


X9 contained in this service manual are indicated when these models are
common to all their corresponding models as given below.
Abbreviated
model name
All model
names
SLV-

SE610

SE710

SE810

SX710

SX717

SX810

X9

SE610A
SE610B
SE610E
SE610G
SE610K
SE610N

SE710B
SE710D
SE710E
SE710G
SE710I
SE710K
SE710N

SE810B
SE810D
SE810E
SE810G
SE810K
SE810N

SX710B
SX710D
SX710E
SX710K
SX710N

SX717D
SX717E

SX810D

X9B
X9D
X9E
X9G
X9N

VIDEO CASSETTE RECORDER

SPECIFICATIONS

System

RF output signal
UHF channels 2169
Aerial out
75-ohm asymmetrical aerial socket
Tape speed
SLV-SE610N/K, SE710N/K, SE810N/K, SX710N/K, X9N
SP: PAL/MESECAM
23.39 mm/s (recording/playback)
NTSC
33.35 mm/s (playback only)
LP: PAL/MESECAM
11.70 mm/s (recording/playback)
NTSC
16.67 mm/s (playback only)
EP: NTSC
11.12 mm/s (playback only)
SLV-SE610B, SE710B, SE810B, SX710B, X9B
SP: PAL 23.39 mm/s (recording/playback)
NTSC 33.35 mm/s (playbackonly)
SECAM 23.39 mm/s (recording/playback)
MESECAM 23.39 mm/s (playback only)
LP: PAL 11.70 mm/s (recording/playback)
NTSC 16.67 mm/s (playback only)
SECAM 11.70 mm/s (recording/playback)
MESECAM 1.70 mm/s (playback only)
EP: NTSC 11.12 mm/s (playback only)
SLV-SE610A/E/G, SE710D/E/G/I, SE810D/E/G, X9D/E/G,
SX710D/E, SX717D/G, SX810D,
SP: PAL23.39 mm/s (recording/playback)
NTSC33.35 mm/s (playback only)
LP: PAL11.70 mm/s (recording/playback)
NTSC16.67 mm/s (playback only)
EP: NTSC11.12 mm/s (playback only)
Maximum recording/playback time
10 hrs. in LP mode (with E300 tape)
Fast-forward and rewind time
Approx. 1 min. (with E180 tape)

Channel coverage
SLV-SE610N/K, SE710N/K, SE810N/K, SX710N/K, X9N
PAL (B/G, D/K)
VHF E2E12, R1R12
UHF E21E69, R21R69
CATV S1S41, S01S05
SLV-SE610B, SE710B, SE810B, SX710B, X9B
SECAM (L):
VHF F2 to F10
UHF F21 to F69
CATV B to Q
HYPER S21 to S41
PAL (B/G):
VHF E2 to E12
VHF Italian channel A to H
UHF E21 to E69
CATV S01 to S05, S1 to S20
HYPER S21 to S41
RF output signal
SLV-SE610A/E, SE710D/E, SE810D/E, X9D/E,
SX710D/E, SX717D/E, SX810D/E
PAL (B/ G)
VHF E2 to E12
VHF Italian channel A to H
UHF E21 to E69
CATV S01 to S05,S1toS20
HYPER S21 to S41
SLVSE610G, SE710G/I, SE810G, X9G
PAL (I)
VHF IA to IJ, SA10 to SA13 (SLV-SE710I)
UHF B21 to B69
CATV S01 to S05, S1 to S20 (SLV-SE710I)
HYPER S21 to S41 (SLV-SE710I)

SAFETY CHECK-OUT
After correcting the original service problem, perform the following
safety checks before releasing the set to the customer:
1. Check the area of your repair for unsoldered or poorly-soldered connections. Check the entire board surface for solder
splashes and bridges.

4. Look for parts which, though functioning, show obvious signs


of deterioration. Point them out to the customer and recommend their replacement.

2. Check the interboard wiring to ensure that no wires are


pinched or contact high-wattage resistors.

5. Check the B+ voltage to see it is at the values specified.

3. Look for unauthorized replacement parts, particularly transistors, that were installed during a previous repair. Point them
out to the customer and recommend their replacement.
SAFETY-RELATED COMPONENT WARNING!!
COMPONENTS IDENTIFIED BY MARK 0 OR DOTTED
LINE WITH MARK 0 ON THE SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
AND IN THE PARTS LIST ARE CRITICAL TO SAFE
OPERATION. REPLACE THESE COMPONENTS WITH
SONY PARTS WHOSE PART NUMBERS APPEAR AS
SHOWN IN THIS MANUAL OR IN SUPPLEMENTS PUBLISHED BY SONY.

Inputs and outputs

SLV-SE810G, X9G
t LINE-2 IN L o R
VIDEO IN, phono jack (1)
Input signal: 1 Vp-p, 75 ohms,
unbalanced, sync negative
AUDIO IN, phono jack (2)
Input level: 327 mVrms
Input impedance: more than 47 kilohms
o R/D L/G
Phono jack (2)
Rated output level: 327 mVrms
Load impedance: 47 kilohms
Output impedance: less than 10 kilohms

i LINE-1 (TV)
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6
Video output: pin 19
Audio output: pins 1 and 3
SLV-SE610E, SE710D/E/N/K, SX710D/E/N/K, SX717D/E
DECODER/t LINE-2 IN
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6
SLV-SE810D/E/N/K, SX810D, X9E/N
DECODER/t LINE-3 IN
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6
SLV-SE810D/E/N/K, SX810D, X9E/N
t LINE-2 L o R
VIDEO IN, phono jack (1)
Input signal: 1 Vp-p, 75 ohms,
unbalanced, sync negative
AUDIO IN, phono jack (2)
Input level: 327 mVrms
Input impedance: more than 47 kilohms
SLV-SE610B, SE710B, SX710B
DECODEUR/t ENTREE LIGNE-2
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6
SLV-SE810B, X9B
DECODEUR/t ENTREE LIGNE-3
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6
SLV-SE810B, X9B
t LIGNE-2 G o D
ENTREE VIDEO, phono jack (1)
Input signal: 1 Vp-p, 75 ohms,
unbalanced, sync negative
ENTREE AUDIO, phono jack (2)
Input level: 327 mVrms
Input impedance: more than 47 kilohms
SLV-SE710G, SE710I
t LINE-2 IN
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6
SLV-SE810G,X9G
t LINE-3 IN
21-pin
Video input: pin 20
Audio input: pins 2 and 6

General
Power requirements
220 240 V AC, 50 Hz
Power consumption
20 W
SLV-610A/E, SE710D/E/N/K, SE810D/E/N/K, X9D/E/N,
SX710D/E/N/K, SX717D/E, SX810D
1.2 W (POWER SAVE is set to FULL/ON, minimum)
SLV-SE610G, SE710G/I, SE810G
1.2 W (POWER SAVE is set to ON, minimum)
SLV-SE610B, SE710B, SE810B, SX710B, X9B
1.2 W (VEILLE ECO is set to TOTAL, minimum)
Operating temperature
5C to 40C
Storage temperature
20C to 60C
Dimensions including projecting parts and controls
SLV-610A/E/B/N/K/G, SE710B/D/E/N/K/G/I,
SX710B/D/E/N/K, SX710D/E
Approx. 430 98 283 mm (w/h/d)
SLV-SE810B/D/E/N/K/G, SX810D
Approx. 430 98 289 mm (w/h/d)
SLV-X9
Approx. 430 110 285 mm (w/h/d)
Mass
EXCEPT SLV-X9
Approx. 4.1 kg
SLV-X9
Approx. 4.3 kg

Supplied accessories
Remote commander (1)
R6 (size AA) batteries (2)
Aerial cable (1)
Design and specifications are subject to change without notice.

Feature Difference
SLVFEATURE

SE610A

SE610B

SE610E

SE610G

SE610K

SE610N

SE710B

/a

/
/

/
/

SE710D

a/a

a/a

a/a

/a

/
/

21pin 2

21pin 2

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

ME-SECAM (REC/PB)

/
/

EURO INPUT

21pin

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin

21pin

21pin

L/G

G/K

G/K

L/G

V288B

V288C

V288B

V288B

V288B

V288B

V288C

V228B

SE710E

SE710G

SE710I

SE710K

SE710N

SE810B

SE810D

SE810E

/
/

/
/

/
/

a/a

a/a

a/a

/a

/
/

/
/

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin

(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

SECAM (REC/PB)

RCA FRONT LINE INPUT


ADDITIONAL REAR OUTPUT
(AUDIO OUT)
MODULATOR SYSTEM

STB CONTROL
REMOTE COMMANDER RMT-

SLVFEATURE
SECAM (REC/PB)
ME-SECAM (REC/PB)
EURO INPUT

RCA FRONT LINE INPUT


ADDITIONAL REAR OUTPUT
(AUDIO OUT)
MODULATOR SYSTEM
STB CONTROL
REMOTE COMMANDER RMT-

SLVFEATURE
SECAM (REC/PB)
ME-SECAM (REC/PB)
EURO INPUT
RCA FRONT LINE INPUT
ADDITIONAL REAR OUTPUT
(AUDIO OUT)
MODULATOR SYSTEM
REMOTE COMMANDER RMT-

SLVFEATURE
SECAM (REC/PB)
ME-SECAM (REC/PB)
EURO INPUT
RCA FRONT LINE INPUT
ADDITIONAL REAR OUTPUT
(AUDIO OUT)
MODULATOR SYSTEM
STB CONTROL
REMOTE COMMANDER RMT-

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

G/K

G/K

L/G

V288B

V288B

V288B

V288B

V288B

V259L

V259K

V259K

SE810G

SE810K

SE810N

SX710B

SX710D

SX710E

SX710K

SX710N

/
/

a/a

/
/

/
/

a/a

/a

a/a

a/a

a/a

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

G/K

G/K

L/G

G/K

G/K

V259K

V259K

V259K

V288A

V288

V288

V288

V288

SX717D

SX717E

SX810D

X9B

X9D

X9E

X9G

X9N

/
/

/
/

/
/

/a

/
/

/
/

/
/

a/a

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

21pin 2

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

3pin

(R.W.Y)

3pin
(R.W.Y)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

2pin
(R.W)

L/G

G/K

V259S

V259R

V259R

V259R

V259B

STB CONTROL

a/a

2pin
(R.W)
G

V259

V259

V259

a/a

TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section

Title

Page

Section

Feature Difference ................................................................... 4


SERVICE NOTE ...................................................................... 6

1.

GENERAL
Getting Started ..............................................................
Basic Operations ...........................................................
Additional Operations ....................................................
Editing ............................................................................

INTERFACE, IC PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION

5-1.

System Control-Video Block Interface


(MA-400 BOARD IC162) ...............................................
System Control-Servo Peripheral Circuit Interface
(MA-400 BOARD IC162) ...............................................
System Control-Mechanism Block Interface
(MA-400 BOARD IC162) ...............................................
System Control-System Control Peripheral Circuit
Interface (MA-400 BOARD IC162) ................................
System Control-Audio Block Interface
(MA-400 BOARD IC162) ...............................................
Servo/System Control Microprocessor Pin Function
(MA-400 BOARD IC162) ...............................................
Mode Control Pin Function
(MA-400 BOARD IC420) ...............................................

5-3.
5-4.
5-5.

2.

DISASSEMBLY

2-1.
2-2.
2-3.
2-4.
2-5.
2-6.
2-7.
2-8.

Upper Case Removal ....................................................


Rear Panel Removal .....................................................
Power Block (SRV938EK) Removal ..............................
Front Panel Section Removal ........................................
Mechanism Deck Removal ............................................
MA-400 Board Removal ................................................
Internal Views ................................................................
Circuit Boards Location .................................................

3.

BLOCK DIAGRAMS

3-1.
3-2.
3-3.
3-4.
3-5.
3-6.
3-7.

Overall Block Diagram ...................................................


Video Block Diagram .....................................................
Servo/System Control Block Diagram ..........................
Audio Block Diagram .....................................................
Tuner Block Diagram .....................................................
Mode Control Block Diagram ........................................
Power Block Diagram ....................................................

4.

PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND


SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS

4-1.
4-2.

Frame Schematic Diagram ............................................


Printed Wiring Boards and Schematic Diagrams .........
MA-400 Printed Wiring Board .......................................
MA-400 (Video, Audio) Schematic Diagram .................
MA-400 (SECAM) Schematic Diagram .........................
MA-400 (Servo/System Control)
Schematic Diagram .......................................................
MA-400 (Hi-Fi Audio) Schematic Diagram ....................
MA-400 (I/O) Schematic Diagram .................................
MA-400 (Tuner) Schematic Diagram ............................
MA-400 (Mode Control) Schematic Diagram ................
MA-400 (Power Supply) Schematic Diagram ...............
DS-95 Schematic Diagram ............................................
JK-201 Schematic Diagram ..........................................
DS-95 Printed Wiring Board ..........................................
JK-201 Printed Wiring Board ........................................
SRV938EK Printed Wiring Board ..................................
SRV938EK Schematic Diagram ....................................

5-6.
5-7.

2-1
2-1
2-1
2-1
2-2
2-2
2-3
2-4

Page

5.

5-2.
1-1
1-11
1-15
1-21

Title

4-3
4-5
4-5
4-9
4-11
4-13
4-17
4-19
4-21
4-23
4-25
4-27
4-27
4-29
4-29
4-31
4-33

5-2
5-3
5-3
5-4
5-5

ERROR CODES ....................................................... 6-1

7.

ADJUSTMENTS

8.

7-1
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-1
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-2
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-4
7-4
7-4
7-4
7-4
7-4
7-5
7-5
7-6

REPAIR PARTS LIST

8-1. Exploded Views .............................................................


8-1-1. Front Panel and Cabinet Assemblies .......................
8-1-2. Chassis Assembly ....................................................
8-1-3. Mechanism Chassis Assembly (1) ...........................
8-1-4. Mechanism Chassis Assembly (2) ...........................
8-1-5. Mechanism Chassis Assembly (3) ...........................
8-2. Electrical Parts List .......................................................

5-1

6.

7-1. Mechanical Adjustments ...............................................


7-2. Electrical Adjustments ...................................................
2-1. Pre-Adjustment Preparations ........................................
2-1-1. Instruments to be Used ............................................
2-1-2. Connection ...............................................................
2-1-3. Set-up of Adjustment ...............................................
2-1-4. Alignment Tapes .......................................................
2-1-5. Specified I/O Level and Impedance .........................
2-1-6. Adjusting Sequence .................................................
2-2. Power Supply Adjustments ...........................................
2-2-1. Power Supply Check ................................................
2-2-2. +6 V Adjustment .......................................................
2-3. Servo System Adjustment .............................................
2-3-1. RF Switching Position Adjustment ...........................
2-4. Audio System Adjustments ...........................................
2-4-1. Hi-Fi Audio System Adjustment ...............................
1.
AF Switching Position Adjustment ...........................
2.
Frequency Response Check ....................................
3.
Overall Level Characteristic and
Distortion Factor Check ...........................................
4.
Overall S/N Check ....................................................
2-4-2. Normal Audio System Adjustment ...........................
1.
ACE Head Adjustment .............................................
2.
E-E Output Level Check ...........................................
3.
Frequency Response Check ....................................
4.
Overall Level Characteristic and Distortion
Factor Check ............................................................
5.
Overall S/N Check ....................................................
2-5. Parts Arrangement Diagram for Adjustments ...............

3-1
3-3
3-5
3-7
3-9
3-11
3-13

5-1

8-1
8-1
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-6
8-7

SERVICE NOTE
1. DISASSEMBLY
This set can be disassembled in the order shown below.
Note: Pages in
Pages in

indicated pages in the SERVICE MANUAL.


indicated pages in the VHS MECHANICAL ADJUSTMENT MANUAL VI.

Set

Upper Case
(Page 2-1)

Front Panel
Section
(Page 2-1)

Pinch Press
Block Assy
(Page 14)

Ground Shaft
Assy
(Page 13)

FL Complete
Assy
(Page 13)

Mechanism
Deck
(Page 2-2)

Drum
Assy
(Page 13)

Retainer
Plate
(Page 22)

Rubber
Belt
(Page 15)

Rubber
Belt
(Page 15)

MA-400
Board
(Page 2-2)

FL Slider
Block Assy
(Page 22)

Capstan
Motor
(Page 15)

Pully Gear
Assy
(Page 29)

Rotary
Switch

Cam Gear
(Page 23)

Cam Motor
Retainer
(Page 31)

Reel Direct
Assy
(Page 30)

Rubber
Belt
(Page 15)

Cam Motor
(Page 31)

Rear
Panel
(Page 2-1)

Power Block
(SRV938EK)
(Page 2-1)

Slider
(Page 26)

Loading
Gear (T, S)
(Page 28)

Tuner
Unit

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 1
This section is extracted from
GENERAL
instruction manual. (3-065-678-11)
Getting Started

SLV-SE610N/K, SE710N/K, SX710N/K


Getting Started

Index to parts and controls


Refer to the pages indicated in parentheses ( ) for details.

Front panel
SLV-SE810N/K

A ?/1 (on/standby) switch (19)

I M (fast-forward) button (44) (63)

B Tape compartment

J m (rewind) button (44) (63)

C Remote sensor (11)

K PROGRAM +/ buttons (22) (64)


(81)

D A (eject) button (44)


M

B Tape compartment

N PROGRAM +/ buttons (22) (64)


(81)

C Remote sensor (11)

DIAL TIMER (50)

F z REC (record) button (46) (65)


(89)
G X (pause) button (44) (89)

O AUDIO DUB button (90)

D A (eject) button (44)


F H (play) button (44) (63)
G JOG button (64)
H z REC (record) button (46) (65)
(89)
I X (pause) button (44) (89)
J x (stop) button (44) (89)
K M (fast-forward) button (44) (63)
L m (rewind) button (44) (63)

L AUTO SET UP/


RF (Radio Frequency) CHANNEL
button (19) (22)
M SYNCHRO REC (Synchronized
Recording) button* (67)

H x (stop) button (44) (89)

P AUTO SET UP/


RF (Radio Frequency) CHANNEL
button (19) (22)

E Shuttle ring (63)

E H (play) button (44) (63)

A ?/1 (on/standby) switch (19)

* not available on SLV-SE610N/K

Q SYNCHRO REC (Synchronized


Recording) button (67)
R t LINE-2 L (left) o R (right)
jacks (covered) (87) (88)
How to open the jack cover
1 Press the bottom of the cover.
2 Hook your finger on the top edge of the
cover and pull it open.

continued
Index to parts and controls

Index to parts and controls

Display window

Rear panel

VPS SPLP OPC


PDC EP

Getting Started

STEREO NICAM VIDEO


SYNCHRO

TV

RR

A Timer indicator (52) (57) (60)


B SYNCHRO indicator*1 (67)
C STEREO indicator (70)
D NICAM indicator*2 (70)
E

(smartlink) indicator*1 (17)

F VIDEO indicator (16) (47)


G VPS (Video Programme System)/
PDC (Programme Delivery Control)
indicator*1 (57)
H Tape speed indicators (46)

I OPC (Optimum Picture Control)


indicator (82)

A Mains lead (15) (16)


B DECODER/t LINE-2 IN
DECODEUR/t ENTREE LIGNE2 connector*1 (18) (39) (66) (88)

J TV indicator*1 (48)
K Audio dubbing indicator*3 (90)

DECODER/t LINE-3 IN
DECODEUR/t ENTREE LIGNE3 connector*2 (18) (39) (66) (88)

L Tracking indicator (81)


M Time counter/clock/line/programme
position indicator (44) (46) (89)

C AERIAL IN
ANTENNE ENTREE connector (15)
(16)

N Remaining time indicator (47)


O RR (Reality Regenerator) indicator
(81)

D AERIAL OUT
ANTENNE SORTIE connector (15)
(16)
E i LINE-1 (TV)
i LIGNE-1 (TV) connector (16)
(39)
F

(audio out) R/D (right) L/G (left)


jacks*3 (18)

*1 SLV-SE710N/K and SX710N/K only


*2 SLV-SE810N/K only
*3 not available on SLV-SE610N/K

P Tape/recording indicator (46)

*1 not available on SLV-SE610N/K


*2 SLV-SE610N, SE710N, SX710N, and SE810N only
*3 SLV-SE810N/K only

continued
Index to parts and controls

Index to parts and controls

1-1

A Z EJECT button (44)

Remote commander

N ?/1 (on/standby) switch (12) (57)

C AUDIO MONITOR button (70)

O COUNTER/REMAIN button (47)


/ (Teletext) button*2 (for TV) (13)

D 2 button* (63)
E y SLOW button* (63)

P a TV power on/TV mode select


button*2 (for TV) (12)

F SP (Standard Play)/LP (Long Play)


button (46)
DISPLAY button (47)

Q ./> INDEX SEARCH


buttons*1 (80)

H - (tens digit) button (12) (47)

R CLEAR button (44) (56) (68)

S t TV/VIDEO button (12) (16) (47)

I 2 (volume) +/ buttons (for TV)


(13)
1

T Programme number buttons (12) (47)

J z REC (record) button (46) (65)

K MENU button (25) (68)

U INPUT SELECT button (47) (60)


(89)
V PROG (programme) +/ buttons (12)
(31) (46)
c/C Teletext page access buttons*2
(for TV) (13)

L X PAUSE/M button (25) (44)


x STOP/m button (25) (44)
m REW (rewind)/< button (44)
(63)
M FF (fast-forward)/, button
(44) (63)
H PLAY/OK button (25) (44)

TIMER button (55) (59)

X SMART SEARCH button (73)

* FASTEXT buttons (for TV) (SLVSE810N/K only)

*1 FASTEXT buttons (for TV) (SLVSE810N/K only)


*2 SLV-SE810N/K only

Index to parts and controls

Index to parts and controls

Step 2 : Setting up the remote commander


Inserting the batteries

Check that you have received the following items with the VCR:

Insert two R6 (size AA) batteries


by matching the + and on the
batteries to the diagram inside the
battery compartment.

Aerial cable

Getting Started

Step 1 : Unpacking

Remote commander

Getting Started

M [TV] / [VIDEO] remote control switch


(11)

B WIDE button (for TV) (13)

Insert the negative () end first,


then push in and down until the
positive (+) end clicks into
position.

Using the remote


commander

R6 (size AA) batteries

You can use this remote


commander to operate this VCR
and a Sony TV. Buttons on the
remote commander marked with a
dot () can be used to operate your
Sony TV. If the TV does not have
the
symbol near the remote
sensor, this remote commander
will not operate the TV.

Check your model name


The instructions in this manual are for the 8 models: SLV-SE610N, SE610K,
SE710N, SE710K, SX710N, SX710K, SE810N, and SE810K. Check your
model number by looking at the rear panel of your VCR.
SLV-SE810N is the model used for illustration purposes. Any difference in
operation is clearly indicated in the text, for example, SLV-SE710N only.

Remote sensor

[TV] /
[VIDEO]

10

To operate

Set [TV] / [VIDEO] to

the VCR

[VIDEO] and point at the remote sensor at the VCR

a Sony TV

[TV] and point at the remote sensor at the TV


continued
Setting up the remote commander

Unpacking

1-2

11

Press
2 +/

Switch to TV (Teletext off)*

a (TV)

Switch to Teletext*

/ (Teletext)

?/1
1

Select the sound

AUDIO MONITOR

WIDE

Use FASTEXT*

FASTEXT buttons

AUDIO MONITOR

Call up the on-screen display

FASTEXT buttons
t TV/VIDEO

DISPLAY

Programme
number
buttons

DISPLAY

Change the Teletext page*

c/C

Switch to/from wide mode of a Sony wide TV (For


other manufactures wide TVs, see Controlling
other TVs with the remote commander (SLVSE810N/K only) below.)

WIDE

PROG +//
c/C

Notes
With normal use, the batteries should last about three to six months.
If you do not use the remote commander for an extended period of time, remove
the batteries to avoid possible damage from battery leakage.
Do not use a new battery together with an old one.
Do not use different types of batteries together.
Some buttons may not work with certain Sony TVs.

2 +/

* SLV-SE810N/K only

Getting Started

To
Adjust the volume of the TV

Controlling other TVs with the remote commander


(SLV-SE810N/K only)
The remote commander is preprogrammed to control non-Sony TVs. If your
TV is listed in the following table, set the appropriate manufacturers code
number.

1 Set [TV] / [VIDEO] at the top of the remote commander to [TV].


down ?/1, and enter your TVs code number using the programme
2 Hold
number buttons. Then release ?/1.
Now you can use the following TV control buttons to control your TV:
?/1, t TV/VIDEO, programme number buttons, - (tens digit),
PROG +/, 2 +/, a (TV), / (Teletext), FASTEXT buttons, WIDE*,
MENU*, M/m/</,*, and OK*.

TV control buttons

12

To

Press

Set the TV to standby mode

?/1

Select an input source: aerial in or line in

t TV/VIDEO

Select the TVs programme position

Programme number buttons,


-, PROG +/

* These buttons may not work with all TVs.

continued
Setting up the remote commander

Setting up the remote commander

Step 3 : Connecting the VCR

To switch to wide mode, see the footnotes below this table for the applicable
code numbers.
Manufacturer

Code number

Manufacturer

Code number

Sony

01*1, 02

Panasonic

17*1, 49

Akai

68

Philips

06*1, 07*1, 08*1

Ferguson

52

Saba

12, 13

Grundig

10*1, 11*1

Samsung

22, 23

Hitachi

24

Sanyo

25

JVC

33

Sharp

29

Loewe

45

Telefunken

36

Mivar

09, 70

Thomson

43*2

NEC

66

Toshiba

38

Nokia

15, 16, 69*3

If your TV has a Scart (EURO-AV) connector, see page 16.

If your TV does not have a Scart (EURO-AV) connector

Getting Started

Code numbers of controllable TVs


If more than one code number is listed, try entering them one at a time until
you find the one that works with your TV.

13

AERIAL IN

AERIAL OUT
Mains lead
AERIAL IN

to mains

Aerial cable (supplied)

: Signal flow

*1 Press WIDE to switch the wide picture mode on or off.


*2 Press WIDE, then press 2 +/ to select the wide picture mode you want.
*3 Press WIDE. The menu appears on the TV screen. Then, press M/m/</, to
select the wide picture you want and press OK.

Tip
When you set your TVs code number correctly while the TV is turned on, the TV
turns off automatically.

Notes
If you enter a new code number, the code number previously entered will be
erased.
If the TV uses a different remote control system from the one programmed to work
with the VCR, you cannot control your TV with the remote commander.
When you replace the batteries of the remote commander, the code number may
change. Set the appropriate code number every time you replace the batteries.

Disconnect the aerial cable from


your TV and connect it to
AERIAL IN on the rear panel of
the VCR.

Connect AERIAL OUT of the


VCR and the aerial input of your
TV using the supplied aerial cable.

AERIAL
ANTENNE
IN
ENTREE

OUT
SORTIE

AERIAL
ANTENNE
IN
ENTREE

OUT
SORTIE

Connect the mains lead to the mains.


Note
When you connect the VCR and your TV only with an aerial cable, you have to
tune your TV to the VCR (see page 19).

14

continued
Connecting the VCR

Setting up the remote commander

1-3

15

If your TV has a Scart (EURO-AV) connector

About the SMARTLINK features (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

AERIAL IN

i LINE-1
(TV)

Mains lead

AERIAL OUT
AERIAL IN

Preset Download
You can download your TV tuner preset data to this VCR and tune the
VCR according to that data in Auto Set Up. This greatly simplifies the
Auto Set Up procedure. Be careful not to disconnect the cables or exit the
Auto Set Up function during the procedure.
See Setting up the VCR with the Auto Set Up function on page 22.
TV Direct Rec
You can easily record what you are watching on the TV. For details, see
Recording what you are watching on the TV (TV Direct Rec) (not
available on SLV-SE610N/K) on page 48.
One Touch Play
With One Touch Play, you can start playback automatically without
turning on the TV. For details, see Starting playback automatically with
one button (One Touch Play) (not available on SLV-SE610N/K) on page
45.
One Touch Menu
You can turn on the VCR and TV, set the TV to the video channel, and
display the VCRs on-screen display automatically by pressing MENU on
the remote commander.
One Touch Timer
You can turn on the VCR and TV, set the TV to the video channel, and
display the timer recording menu (the TIMER METHOD menu, the
TIMER menu, or the SHOWVIEW menu) automatically by pressing
TIMER on the remote commander.
You can set which timer recording menu is displayed using TIMER
OPTIONS in the OPTIONS-2 menu (see page 85).
Automatic Power Off
You can have the VCR turn off automatically, if the VCR is not used after
you turn off the TV.

to mains
Aerial cable (supplied)

Scart
(EURO-AV)

: Signal flow
Scart cable (not supplied)

Disconnect the aerial cable from


your TV and connect it to
AERIAL IN on the rear panel of
the VCR.

IN
ENTREE

Connect AERIAL OUT of the


VCR and the aerial input of your
TV using the supplied aerial cable.

IN
ENTREE

AERIAL
ANTENNE

OUT
SORTIE

AERIAL
ANTENNE

OUT
SORTIE

Connect LINE-1 (TV) on the VCR


and the Scart (EURO-AV)
connector on the TV with the
optional Scart cable.
This connection improves picture
and sound quality. Whenever you
want to watch the VCR picture,
press t TV/VIDEO to display
the VIDEO indicator in the
display window.

*1 MEGALOGIC is a registered trademark of Grundig Corporation.


*2 EASYLINK is a trademark of Philips Corporation.
*3 Q-Link is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation.
*4 EURO VIEW LINK is a trademark of Toshiba Corporation.
*5 T-V LINK is a trademark of JVC Corporation.

Connect the mains lead to the mains.


Note
If the TV is connected to the LINE-1 (TV) connector, setting the RF channel to
OFF is recommended. In the OFF position, only the signal from the aerial is
output through the AERIAL OUT connector (see page 21).

16

Getting Started

If the connected TV complies with


SMARTLINK, MEGALOGIC*1,
EASYLINK*2, Q-Link*3, EURO
VIEW LINK*4, or T-V LINK*5, this
VCR automatically runs the
SMARTLINK function after you complete the steps on the previous page
(the
indicator appears in the VCRs display window when you turn on the
TV). You can enjoy the following SMARTLINK features.

Note
Not all TVs respond to the functions above.
continued
Connecting the VCR

Connecting the VCR

17

Additional connections

Step 4 : Tuning your TV to the VCR


R/D L/G

If your TV has a Scart (EURO-AV) connector, see page 21.


LINE IN

If your TV does not have a Scart (EURO-AV) connector

Getting Started

To a stereo system
(not available on
SLV-SE610N/K)
You can improve sound
quality by connecting a
stereo system to the
R/D
L/G jacks as shown on the
right.

Follow the steps below so that your TV will properly receive the video
signals from your VCR.

Audio cable (not supplied)


: Signal flow

?/1
1

To a satellite or digital
tuner with Line Through
(not available on
SLV-SE610N/K)
DECODER/
LINE OUT
t LINE-3 IN*1
Using the Line Through
or DECODER/
function, you can watch
2
t LINE-2 IN*
programmes from a satellite
or digital tuner connected to
this VCR on the TV even
Scart cable (not supplied)
when the VCR is turned off.
When you turn on the
: Signal flow
satellite or digital tuner, this
VCR automatically sends the
signal from the satellite or digital tuner to the TV without turning itself on.

RF CHANNEL

PROGRAM +/

Press ?/1 (on/standby) to turn on the VCR.

1
2

AUTO
SET UP

The factory-preset RF channel appears in the display window.


RF CHANNEL

the satellite or digital tuner to the DECODER/LINE-3 IN* (or


1 Connect
DECODER/LINE-2 IN* ) connector as shown above.
DECODER/LINE3* (or DECODER/LINE2* ) to LINE3* (or
2 Set
LINE2* ) in the OPTIONS-2 menu.
Set POWER SAVE to OFF or PARTIAL* in the OPTIONS-2 menu.
3
4 Turn off the VCR.
1

Press RF CHANNEL on the VCR lightly.


The VCR signal is output through this channel to the TV.

Turn on your TV and select a programme position for the VCR


picture.
This programme position will now be referred to as the video
channel.

To watch a programme, turn on the satellite or digital tuner and the TV.

Note
You cannot watch programmes on the TV while recording unless you are recording
a satellite or digital programme.

Press RF CHANNEL.
The TV system appears in the display window.

RF CHANNEL

*1 SLV-SE810N/K only
*2 SLV-SE710N/K and SX710N/K only
*3 not available on SLV-SE610N/K

18

AUTO
SET UP

continued
Tuning your TV to the VCR

Connecting the VCR

1-4

19

PROGRAM

If your TV has a Scart (EURO-AV) connector

Press PROGRAM +/ (repeatedly) to select the appropriate TV


system for your area. Select G for the B/G TV system, or K for
the D/K TV system.
Tune the TV to the same channel
shown in the VCR display window
so that the picture on the right
appears clearly on the TV screen.

?/1
1

RF CHANNEL

SONY VIDEO CASSETTE RECORDER

PROGRAM +/

Refer to your TV manual for TV


tuning instructions.

AUTO
SET UP

Getting Started

If you select the wrong TV system in


step 5, the picture on the right may
not appear. Select the appropriate TV system and tune the TV
again.

If the picture does not appear clearly, see To obtain a clear picture
from the VCR below.

Press ?/1 (on/standby) to turn on the VCR.

AUTO
SET UP

The factory-preset RF channel appears in the display window.

Press RF CHANNEL.
RF CHANNEL

You have now tuned your TV to the VCR. Whenever you want to
play a tape, set the TV to the video channel.

Press RF CHANNEL on the VCR lightly.


The VCR signal is output through this channel to the TV.

RF CHANNEL

To check to see if the TV tuning is correct


Set the TV to the video channel and press PROGRAM +/ on the VCR. If
the TV screen changes to a different programme each time you press
PROGRAM +/, the TV tuning is correct.

To obtain a clear picture from the VCR


If the screen does not appear clearly in step 6 above, go to step 7 to finish this
procedure once. Then start again from step 2. After pressing RF
CHANNEL in step 2, press PROGRAM +/ while the RF channel is
displayed, so that another RF channel appears. Then tune the TV to the new
RF channel so that a clear picture appears.

PROGRAM

Press PROGRAM +/ to set the RF channel to OFF, and press RF


CHANNEL again.

AUTO
SET UP

RF channel set up is complete.


RF CHANNEL

Note
If you set the wrong TV system, you may have no sound or sound may be distorted.

20

Tuning your TV to the VCR

Tuning your TV to the VCR

RF CHANNEL

Press AUTO SET UP lightly.


The VCR starts searching for all of the receivable channels and
presets them according to the TV system you selected in Tuning
your TV to the VCR on page 19.
If you want to change the order of the channels or disable unwanted
programme positions, see Changing/disabling programme
positions on page 34.

Before using the VCR for the first time, set up the VCR using the Auto Set
Up function. With this function, you can set the language for the on-screen
display, TV channels, guide channels for the ShowView system*, and VCR
clock* automatically.

1
?/1

AUTO
SET UP

Getting Started

Step 5 : Setting up the VCR with the Auto


Set Up function

21

If you use the SMARTLINK connection (not available on SLVSE610N/K), the Preset Download function starts and the
indicator flashes in the display window during download.

AUTO SET UP

For SLV-SE710N/K, SX710N/K, and SE810N/K:


After the search or download is complete, the current time appears
in the display window for any stations that transmit a time signal.
PROGRAM +/

AUTO
SET UP

RF CHANNEL

PROGRAM

For SLV-SE610N/K:
When no more receivable channels can be found, presetting stops
and SET UP disappears from the display window.

Hold down AUTO SET UP on the VCR for more than three
seconds.

The abbreviations of the countries and languages are as follows:

The VCR automatically turns on, and the country abbreviation


appears in the display window.

Press PROGRAM +/ to select the abbreviation of your country


from the table on page 23.
For some countries, there is a selection of languages to choose from.
If your country does not appear, select ELSE.

Abbreviation

Country

Language

CZ

Czecho

Czech

HUN

Hungary

Hungarian

PL

Poland

Polish

SK

Slovakia

Slovak

TR

Turkey

Turkish

RUS

Russia

Russian

ELSE

Other countries

English

To cancel the Auto Set Up function


Press AUTO SET UP.
Tip
If you want to change the language for the on-screen display from the one preset in
the Auto Set Up function, see page 29.

22

continued
Setting up the VCR with the Auto Set Up function

Setting up the VCR with the Auto Set Up function

1-5

23

Step 6 : Setting the clock


You must set the time and date on the VCR to use the timer features properly.

* not available on SLV-SE610N/K

The Auto Clock Set function (not available on SLV-SE610N/K) works only if a station
in your area is broadcasting a time signal. If the Auto Set Up function did not set the
clock correctly for your local area, try another station for the Auto Clock Set function.

Getting Started

Notes
If you stop the Auto Set Up function during step 3, you must repeat set up from
step 1.
Whenever you operate the Auto Set Up function, some of the settings
(ShowView*, timer, etc.) will be reset. If this happens, you have to set them again.

Setting the clock manually


Before you start
Turn on the VCR and the TV.
Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight SETTINGS and press OK.

SETTINGS
TUNER
CLOCK
LANGUAGE
RETURN

PLAY

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

EXIT : MENU

PLAY
OK

Press M/m to highlight CLOCK,


then press OK.
For SLV-SE610N/K, only the clock
setting menu appears. Skip the next
step and go to step 4.

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
1 . 1 . 2001

OFF
MON

0 : 00

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight MANUAL


ADJUST, then press OK.

OK

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
1 . 1 . 2001

OFF
MON

0 : 00

SELECT
:
SET
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

24

continued
Setting the clock

Setting up the VCR with the Auto Set Up function

Press M/m to set the day.


PLAY
OK

Changing the station for the Auto Clock Set function


(not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 1 . 2001

Getting Started

OFF
SUN

Before you start

0 : 00

Turn on the VCR and the TV.


Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

SELECT
:
SET
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

PLAY

Press , to highlight the month and


set the month pressing M/m.

OK

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight SETTINGS and press OK.

OFF
FRI

25

SETTINGS
TUNER
CLOCK
LANGUAGE
RETURN

0 : 00
PLAY

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

SELECT
:
SET
:
CONFIRM : OK

EXIT : MENU

EXIT : MENU

PLAY
OK

Set the year, hour, and minutes in


sequence, pressing , to highlight
the item to be set, and press M/m to
select the digits.
The day of the week is set
automatically.

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

OFF
FRI

PLAY
OK

Press M/m to highlight CLOCK,


then press OK.
AUTO ADJUST is highlighted.

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

ON
1
FRI

AAB

18 : 00

18 : 00

SELECT :
SET
: OK

SELECT
:
SET
:
CONFIRM : OK

EXIT : MENU
EXIT : MENU

Press OK to start the clock.


PLAY
OK

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

OFF
FRI

Press OK.
PLAY

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

OK

ON
OFF
FRI

18 : 00

18 : 00

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK

SELECT :
SET
: OK

EXIT : MENU
EXIT : MENU

MENU

Press MENU to exit the menu.

PLAY
OK

Tips
To change the digits while setting, press < to return to the item to be changed, and
select the digits by pressing M/m.
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.

Press M/m to highlight ON, then


press OK.

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

ON
1
FRI

AAB

18 : 00

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

Note
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.

26

continued
Setting the clock

Setting the clock

1-6

27

PLAY

Press m to highlight CLOCK


PROGRAM, then press OK.

OK

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

Selecting a language
1
FRI

AAB

You can change the on-screen display language from the one you selected with the
Auto Set Up function.

18 : 00

Before you start

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

PLAY
OK

Press M/m repeatedly until the


programme position of the station
that carries a time signal appears.
If the VCR does not receive a time
signal from any station, AUTO
ADJUST returns to OFF
automatically.

Turn on the VCR and the TV.


Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

CLOCK
AUTO ADJUST
CLOCK PROGRAM
MANUAL ADJUST
28 . 9 . 2001

Getting Started

2
FRI

CDE

18 : 00

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight SETTINGS and press OK.

SETTINGS
TUNER
CLOCK
LANGUAGE
RETURN

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU
PLAY

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

MENU

EXIT : MENU

Press MENU to exit the menu.

2
Tips
If you set AUTO ADJUST to ON, the Auto Clock Set function is activated
whenever the VCR is turned off. The time is adjusted automatically by making
reference to the time signal from the station whose programme position is
displayed in the CLOCK PROGRAM row. If you do not need the Auto Clock
Set, select OFF.
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight


LANGUAGE, then press OK.

LANGUAGE

OK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

Note
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.

Press M/m to highlight the desired language, then press OK.


PLAY
OK

MENU

Press MENU to exit the menu.

Tip
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.
Note
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.

28

Setting the clock

Selecting a language

PROG

Press PROG +/ to select the


programme position.

Selected programme position


TUNER
PROG.

If some channels could not be preset using the Auto Set Up function, you can preset
them manually.

SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

Before you start


Turn on the VCR and the TV.
Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight SETTINGS and press OK.

D/K
NORMAL
C1 2
AAB
OFF
ON

Getting Started

Presetting channels

29

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

SETTINGS
TUNER
CLOCK
LANGUAGE
RETURN

PLAY
OK

Press M/m to highlight CHANNEL


SET, then press OK.

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
C1 2

AAB

ON

PLAY

PLAY

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

EXIT : MENU

EXIT : MENU

Press M/m to highlight TUNER,


then press OK.

OK

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
NORMAL
C1 2
AAB
OFF
ON

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight NORMAL/


CATV, then press OK.

OK

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

NORMAL
CATV
ON

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

PLAY
OK

Press M/m to highlight NORMAL,


then press OK.
To preset CATV (Cable Television)
channels, select CATV.

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
NORMAL
C1 2
AAB
OFF
ON

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

30

continued
Presetting channels

Presetting channels

1-7

31

Press M/m repeatedly until the


channel you want is displayed.

PLAY

PROG.

The channels appear in the following


order:
B/G TV system

TUNER
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

OK

D/K
C2 7

10

ON

Receivable
Channel

C02
C03

EXIT : MENU

If the picture is not clear


Normally, the Auto Fine Tuning (AFT) function automatically tunes in
channels clearly. However, if the picture is not clear, you may also use the
manual tuning function.

Channel
number in the
CHANNEL
SET field

Receivable
Channel

E2

C02

R1

E3

C05

R6

C04

E4

C06

R7

C05

E5

C12

R12

C06

E6

C13

R2

C07

E7

C14

R3

TUNER

C08

E8

C15

R4

C09

E9

C16

R5

C10

E10

C17

R8

SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

C11

E11

C18

R9

C12

E12

C19

R10

C21C69

E21E69

C20

R11

S01S41

S1S41

C21C69

R21R69

S42S46

S01S05

PROG +/ or the programme number buttons to select the


1 Press
programme position for which you cannot obtain a clear picture.
2 Press MENU, then select SETTINGS and press OK.
3 Select TUNER, then press OK.
4 Select FINE TUNING, then press OK.
The fine tuning meter appears.
PROG.

PLAY
OK

If the TV sound is distorted or noisy,


press M/m to highlight SYSTEM
and press OK. Then press M/m to
select B/G or D/K so that you get
better sound.

EXIT : MENU

PROG.

SELECT
CONFIRM

Selected programme
position

5 Press </, to get a clearer picture, then press MENU to exit the menu.
Note that the AFT (Auto Fine Tuning) setting switches to OFF.

Tip
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.
Notes
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.
When adjusting FINE TUNING, the menu may become difficult to read due to
interference from the picture being received.

TUNER
4

D/K
B/G

SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
NORMAL
C2 7
OFF

SET :

If you know the number of the channel you want, press the
programme number buttons. For example, for channel 5, first press
0 and then press 5.

Press MENU to exit the menu.

MENU

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK

D/K TV system

Channel
number in the
CHANNEL
SET field

To preset another programme position, repeat steps 5 through 7.


Getting Started

OFF
ON

:
: OK
EXIT : MENU

32

Presetting channels

Presetting channels

PLAY
OK

After setting the channels, you can change the programme positions as you like. If
any programme positions are unused or contain unwanted channels, you can disable
them.

The selected channel is inserted at


the new programme position and the
intermediate channels are displaced
to fill the gap.

You can also change the station names (not available on SLV-SE610N/K). If the
station names are not displayed, you can enter them manually.

Changing programme positions


Before you start

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight LISTS and press OK.

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

SELECT
SET STATION NAME
CONFIRM

NAME
CDE

CH
C0 3
C5 6
C1 2
C2 7
C0 9

AAB
FGH

:
:
: OK
EXIT : MENU

Press OK to confirm the setting.


PLAY
OK

Turn on the VCR and the TV.


Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

Press M/m until the selected channel


row moves to the desired
programme position.

Getting Started

Changing/disabling programme positions

33

To change the programme position of another station, repeat steps 3


through 5.

LISTS

CHANNEL LIST
TIMER LIST
RETURN

MENU

Press MENU to exit the menu.

PLAY

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

PLAY

Tip
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.

EXIT : MENU

Press M/m to highlight CHANNEL


LIST, then press OK.

OK

Note
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

SELECT
MOVE PROGRAM
ERASE PROGRAM

NAME
AAB
CDE

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

Disabling unwanted programme positions

FGH

After presetting channels, you can disable unused programme positions. The disabled
positions will be skipped later when you press the PROG +/ buttons.

:
:
: CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

PLAY
OK

Press M/m to highlight the row


which you want to change the
programme position, then press ,.
To display other pages for
programme positions 6 to 60, press
M/m repeatedly.

Before you start


CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

SELECT
SET STATION NAME
CONFIRM

Turn on the VCR and the TV.


Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

NAME
AAB
CDE

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

FGH

:
:
: OK

MENU

EXIT : MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight LISTS, and press OK.

LISTS
CHANNEL LIST
TIMER LIST
RETURN

PLAY
OK

34

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

continued
Changing/disabling programme positions

Changing/disabling programme positions

1-8

35

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight CHANNEL


LIST, then press OK.

OK

Changing the station names (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)


CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

SELECT
MOVE PROGRAM
ERASE PROGRAM

You can change or enter the station names (up to 5 characters). The VCR must
receive channel information (for instance, SMARTLINK information) for station
names to appear automatically.

NAME
AAB
CDE

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

FGH

Before you start

:
:
: CLEAR

Turn on the VCR and the TV.


Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

EXIT : MENU

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight the row


which you want to disable.

OK

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

SELECT
MOVE PROGRAM
ERASE PROGRAM

NAME
AAB
CDE

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight LISTS and press OK.

LISTS
CHANNEL LIST
TIMER LIST
RETURN

FGH

:
:
: CLEAR

PLAY

EXIT : MENU

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

CLEAR

Press CLEAR.
The selected row will be cleared as
shown on the right.

Getting Started

EXIT : MENU

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

SELECT
MOVE PROGRAM
ERASE PROGRAM

CH
C1 2
C0 3

NAME
AAB
CDE

C2 7
C0 9

FGH

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight CHANNEL


LIST, then press OK.

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

OK

:
:
: CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

NAME
AAB
CDE

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

SELECT
MOVE PROGRAM
ERASE PROGRAM

FGH

:
:
: CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

5
6

Repeat steps 3 and 4 for any other programme positions you want to
disable.
MENU

Press MENU to exit the menu.

PLAY
OK

Tip
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.

Press M/m to highlight the row


which you want to change or enter
the station name, then press ,.
To display other pages for
programme positions 6 to 60, press
M/m repeatedly.

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

NAME
AAB
CDE

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

SELECT
SET STATION NAME
CONFIRM

FGH

:
:
: OK
EXIT : MENU

Notes
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.
Be sure to select the programme position you want to disable correctly. If you
disable a programme position by mistake, you need to reset that channel manually.

Press ,.

CHANNEL LIST

PLAY

PROG
1
2
3
4
5

OK

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

SELECT A CHARACTER
NEXT
CONFIRM

NAME
AAB
CDE
FGH

:
:
: OK
EXIT : MENU

36

continued
Changing/disabling programme positions

Changing/disabling programme positions

Enter the station name.


PLAY
OK

1 Press M/m to select a character.


Each time you press M, the
character changes as shown
below.

AtBttZtatbt
tzt0t1tt9t
(symbols) t (blank space) t
A

CHANNEL LIST
PROG
1
2
3
4
5

CH
C1 2
C0 3
C5 6
C2 7
C0 9

SELECT A CHARACTER
NEXT
CONFIRM

Setting the Canal Plus decoder

NAME
CAB
CDE

(not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

FGH

You can watch or record Canal Plus programmes if you connect a decoder
(not supplied) to the VCR.

:
:
: OK
EXIT : MENU

Connecting a decoder

2 Press , to set the next character.


The next space is highlighted.
To correct a character, press </, until the character you want
to correct is highlighted, then reset it.

Scart cable
(not supplied)
DECODER/t LINE-3 IN*1
or
DECODER/t LINE-2 IN*2

You can set up to 5 characters for the station name.

Canal Plus decoder

Scart
(EURO-AV)

Press OK to confirm the new name.


PLAY
OK

AERIAL OUT

i LINE-1 (TV)

Getting Started

37

MENU

Aerial cable
(supplied)

Press MENU to exit the menu.

AERIAL IN

Scart cable (not supplied)

Scart
(EURO-AV)

: Signal flow

Tip
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.

Setting Canal Plus channels

Notes
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.
If you enter a symbol in step 5, it will appear as a blank space in the display
window.

To watch or record Canal Plus programmes, set your VCR to receive the channels
using the on-screen display.
In order to set the channels correctly, be sure to follow all of the steps below.
Before you start
Turn on the VCR, the TV, and the decoder.
Set the TV to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

38

continued
Setting the Canal Plus decoder (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

Changing/disabling programme positions

1-9

39

MENU

Press MENU, then press M/m to


highlight OPTIONS and press OK.

OPTIONS

PLAY

PLAY

Press MENU again. Then press M/


m to highlight SETTINGS and press
OK.

SETTINGS
TUNER
CLOCK
LANGUAGE
RETURN

PLAY

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

MENU

OPTIONS - 1
OPTIONS - 2
RETURN

Press M/m to highlight OPTIONS-2,


then press OK.

OK

OPTIONS - 2
DECODER / LINE3
TIMER OPTIONS
POWER SAVE
TV DIRECT REC
RR
RETURN

SELECT :
SET
: OK

OK

EXIT : MENU

DECODER
VARIABLE
OFF
ON
NORMAL

PLAY

EXIT : MENU

Press M/m to highlight TUNER,


then press OK.

OK

SELECT :
SET
: OK

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

PLAY
OK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

OPTIONS - 2
DECODER / LINE3
TIMER OPTIONS
POWER SAVE
TV DIRECT REC
RR
RETURN

DECODER
LINE3

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight NORMAL/


CATV, then press OK.

OK

ON
NORMAL

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight DECODER,


then press OK.

OK

9
DECODER
VARIABLE
OFF
ON
NORMAL

PLAY
OK

Press M/m to highlight NORMAL,


then press OK.
To preset CATV (Cable Television)
channels, select CATV.

SELECT :
SET
: OK

TUNER
PROG.
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

MENU

D/K
NORMAL
AAB
C1 2
OFF
ON

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

ON

EXIT : MENU

OPTIONS - 2
DECODER / LINE3
TIMER OPTIONS
POWER SAVE
TV DIRECT REC
RR
RETURN

NORMAL
CATV

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

D/K
NORMAL
C1 2
AAB
OFF
ON

EXIT : MENU

Press M/m to highlight DECODER/


LINE3*1 (or DECODER/LINE2*2),
then press OK.

Getting Started

EXIT : MENU

10

Press MENU to exit the menu.


The menu disappears from the TV screen.

PROG

Press PROG +/ to select the desired


programme position.

Selected programme position


TUNER
PROG. 1 5
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
NORMAL
AAB
C1 2
OFF
ON

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

40

continued
Setting the Canal Plus decoder (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

Setting the Canal Plus decoder (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight CHANNEL


SET, then press OK.

OK

16

TUNER
PROG. 1 5
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

MENU

Press MENU to exit the menu.

D/K
C1 2

AAB

ON

Tip
If you want to return to the previous menu, highlight RETURN and press OK.

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

12

PLAY

Press M/m to select the Canal Plus


channels, then press OK.

OK

Notes
The menu disappears automatically if you dont proceed for more than a few
minutes.
To superimpose subtitles while watching Canal Plus programmes, make both
decoder-VCR and VCR-TV connections using 21-pin Scart cables that are
compatible with the RGB signals. You cannot record subtitles on the VCR.
When you watch Canal Plus programmes through the RFU input of the TV, press
t TV/VIDEO so that the VIDEO indicator appears in the display window.
If POWER SAVE is set to FULL, you cannot watch or record Canal Plus
programmes during standby mode. Set POWER SAVE in the OPTIONS-2 menu
to OFF or PARTIAL.

TUNER
PROG. 1 5
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
NORMAL
LMN
C0 2
OFF
ON

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

13

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight PAY-TV/


CANAL+, then press OK.

OK

Getting Started

11

41

TUNER
PROG. 1 5
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

*1 SLV-SE810N/K only
*2 SLV-SE710N/K and SX710N/K only

D/K
NORMAL
ON
OFF

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

14

PLAY

Press M/m to highlight ON, then


press OK.

OK

TUNER
PROG. 1 5
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
NORMAL
LMN
C0 2
ON
ON

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

15

PLAY
OK

If the TV sound is distorted or noisy,


press M/m to highlight SYSTEM
and press OK. Then press M/m to
select B/G or D/K so that you get
better sound.

TUNER
PROG. 1 5
SYSTEM
NORMAL / CATV
CHANNEL SET
PAY - TV / CANAL+
AFT
FINE TUNING
RETURN

D/K
B/G
ON
ON

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

42

Setting the Canal Plus decoder (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

Setting the Canal Plus decoder (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

1-10

43

Basic Operations

Before you start...


Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.

Insert a tape.

The VCR turns on and starts playing


automatically if you insert a tape with
its safety tab removed.
Press H PLAY.
PLAY

When the tape reaches the end, it will rewind automatically.

Starting playback automatically with one button (One


Touch Play) (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

OK

If you use the SMARTLINK connection, you can turn on the VCR and the
TV, set the TV to the video channel, and start playback automatically with
one button.

Additional tasks
To

Press

Stop play

x STOP

Pause play

X PAUSE

Resume play after pause

X PAUSE or H PLAY

Fast-forward the tape

M FF during stop

Rewind the tape

m REW during stop

Eject the tape

Z EJECT

1 Insert a tape.
2

Note
When you use the One Touch Play function, leave the TV on or in the standby
mode.

To use the time counter


Press CLEAR at the point on the tape that you want to find later. The
counter in the display window resets to 0:00:00. Search for the point
afterwards by referring to the counter.
SP

OPC

To display the counter on the TV screen, press


44

The VCR automatically turns on.


If you insert a tape with its safety tab removed, the TV turns on and
switches to the video channel. Playback starts automatically.
Press H PLAY.
The TV turns on and switches to the video channel automatically.
Playback starts.

Tip
When there already is a tape in the VCR, the VCR and the TV turn on, the TV is
set to the video channel, and playback starts automatically in one sequence when
you press H PLAY.

To set the colour system


If the playback picture has no colour, or streaks appear during playback, set
COLOUR SYSTEM in the OPTIONS-1 menu to conform to the system that
the tape was recorded in (see page 85). (Normally set the option to AUTO.)

VIDEO

DISPLAY.

Playing a tape

Playing a tape

Before you start...


Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.

Insert a tape with its safety tab in place.

To record from a decoder, turn it on.

PROG

Press PROG +/ to select the programme position or station name*


you want to record.
VIDEO

SP / LP

1 : 46

OPC

Remaining time

In order to get an accurate remaining time indication, be sure TAPE


LENGTH in the OPTIONS-1 menu is set according to the tape type you use
(see page 85).

Press SP/LP to select the tape speed, SP or LP.

To watch another TV programme while recording

LP (Long Play) provides recording time twice as long as SP.


However, SP (Standard Play) produces better picture and audio
quality.

Press t TV/VIDEO to turn off the VIDEO indicator in the display


1 window.

VIDEO

REC

SP

0 : 00 : 22

Time counter

2 Select another programme position on the TV.

LP OPC

To save a recording
To prevent accidental erasure, break off the
safety tab as illustrated. To record on the
same tape again, cover the tab hole with
adhesive tape.

Press z REC to start recording.


The recording indicator lights up red in the display window.
Recording indicator

VIDEO

Basic Operations

SP

45

To check the remaining time


Press
DISPLAY. With the display on, press COUNTER/REMAIN to
check the remaining time. Each time you press COUNTER/REMAIN, the
time counter and the remaining time appear alternately. The
indicator
indicates the remaining time.

Recording TV programmes

Basic Operations

Notes
The counter resets to 0:00:00 whenever a tape is reinserted.
The counter stops counting when it comes to a portion with no recording.
The time counter does not appear on the TV screen when using an NTSC-recorded
tape.
Depending on your TV, the following may occur while playing an NTSC-recorded
tape:
The picture becomes black and white.
The picture shakes.
No picture appears on the TV screen.
Black streaks appear horizontally on the TV screen.
The colour density increases or decreases.
If you play back a tape in LP or EP mode with the NTSC system, the sound
becomes monaural.
The pictures colour may be affected when playing a MESECAM-recorded tape in
the LP mode.
While setting the menu on the TV screen, buttons for playback on the remote
commander do not function.

Playing a tape

LP OPC

Safety tab

To stop recording
Press x STOP.

46

Tips
To select a programme position, you can use the programme number buttons on the
remote commander. For two-digit numbers, press the - (tens digit) button
followed by the programme number buttons.
If you connect additional equipment to a LINE connector or jack, you can select
the input signal using the INPUT SELECT or PROG +/ buttons.
The
DISPLAY information appears on the TV screen indicating information
about the tape, but the information wont be recorded on the tape.
If you dont want to watch TV while recording, you can turn off the TV. When
using a decoder, make sure to leave it on.

continued
Recording TV programmes

Recording TV programmes

1-11

47

Notes

Notes
You cannot record what you are watching using this method when the VCR is in
the following modes; pause, timer standby, tuner preset, Auto Set Up, and
recording.
When the TV indicator is lit in the display window, do not turn off the TV nor
change the TV programme position. When the TV indicator is not lit, the VCR
continues recording the programme even if you change the TV programme
position on the TV.

Basic Operations

The
DISPLAY information does not appear during still (pause) mode or slowmotion playback.
The
DISPLAY information will not appear while playing an NTSC-recorded
tape.
If a tape has portions recorded in both PAL (MESECAM) and NTSC systems, the
time counter reading will not be correct. This discrepancy is due to the difference
between the counting cycles of the two video systems.
You cannot watch a Canal Plus programme while recording another Canal Plus
programme.*
When you insert a non-standard commercially available tape, the remaining time
may not be correct.
The remaining time is intended for rough measurement only.
About 30 seconds after the tape begins playback, the tape remaining time will be
displayed.
The station name* may not appear if the VCR does not receive station name
information signals.
* not available on SLV-SE610N/K

Recording what you are watching on the TV (TV Direct


Rec) (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)
If you use the SMARTLINK connection, you can easily record what you are
watching on the TV (other than tapes being played on the VCR).

1 Insert a tape with its safety tab in place.


z REC while you are watching a TV programme or external
2 Press
source.
The VCR automatically turns on, then the TV indicator lights up and the
VCR starts recording what you are watching on the TV.
Tips
The TV indicator appears in the display window after you press z REC in some
situations such as:
when you are watching a source connected to the TVs line input, or
when the TV tuner preset data for the programme position is different from the
data in the VCR tuner preset.
If there is a tape with its safety tab in place in the VCR, the VCR automatically
turns on and starts recording what you are watching on the TV when you press
z REC.
You can turn the TV Direct Rec function ON and OFF in the OPTIONS-2 menu
(see page 86).

48

Recording TV programmes

Recording TV programmes

Recording TV programmes using the Dial


Timer

DIAL TIMER

Press

DIAL TIMER.

START and the current time appear alternately in the display


window.

(SLV-SE810N/K only)
1
?/1

DIAL TIMER

PROGRAM +/

Press

DIAL TIMER

Turn

SP

OPC

DIAL TIMER to set the recording start time.

VIDEO

SP

OPC

DIAL TIMER

Press

DIAL TIMER.

STOP and the recording stop time appear alternately in the display
window.

VIDEO

SP

OPC

VIDEO

SP

OPC

VIDEO

SP

OPC

VIDEO

SP

OPC

SP

OPC

DIAL TIMER to set the recording date.


VIDEO

DIAL TIMER

Turn

DIAL TIMER to set the recording stop time.

You can set the recording stop time in 15 minute intervals or adjust
the time in one minute intervals by pressing the PROGRAM +/
buttons.
PROGRAM

50

VIDEO

DIAL TIMER.

If the date and time are not set, DAY will appear. See step 2 in the
following section, To set the clock to set the date and time.

DIAL TIMER

Turn

PROGRAM

DATE and TODAY appear alternately in the display window.

OPC

You can set the recording start time in 15 minute intervals or adjust
the time in one minute intervals by pressing the PROGRAM +/
buttons.

Insert a tape with its safety tab in place. Make sure the tape is longer than the total recording
time.
To record from a decoder, turn it on.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.
DIAL TIMER

SP

Before you start...

VIDEO

Basic Operations

The Dial Timer function allows you to


make timer recordings of programmes
without turning on your TV. Set the
recording timer to record up to eight
programmes, including settings made
with other timer methods, that will be
broadcast within the next month. The
recording start time and recording stop
time can be set at one minute intervals.

49

VIDEO

SP

OPC

continued
Recording TV programmes using the Dial Timer (SLV-SE810N/K only)

Recording TV programmes using the Dial Timer (SLV-SE810N/K only)

1-12

51

DIAL TIMER

Press

To set the clock

DIAL TIMER.

VIDEO

DIAL TIMER

Turn

SP

OPC

DIAL TIMER to set the programme position.

To record from a decoder or other source connected to one or more


of the LINE inputs, turn DIAL TIMER or press INPUT SELECT
to display the connected line in the display window.
VIDEO

INPUT SELECT

DIAL TIMER

Press

SP

OPC

Tips
To cancel a Dial Timer setting, press x (stop) on the VCR while you are making
the setting.
The programme is recorded in the current tape speed mode. To change the tape
speed, press SP/LP before you complete the setting in step 9.
When you are recording a programme in the SP mode and the remaining tape
becomes shorter than the recording time, the tape speed is automatically changed
to the LP mode. Note that some interference will appear on the picture at the point
the tape speed is changed. If you want to keep the same tape speed, set AUTO
LONG PLAY to OFF in the OPTIONS-1 menu (page 85).
To check, change, or cancel the programme setting, see Checking/changing/
cancelling timer settings (page 68).

DIAL TIMER to complete the setting.

OK appears in the display window for about five seconds.


The
indicator appears in the display window and the VCR stands
by for recording.
To record from a decoder or other source, leave the connected
equipment switched on.
To return to the previous step
To return to the previous step, press the PROGRAM + and buttons on the
VCR at the same time during any of the Dial Timer settings.

Notes
If eight programmes have already been set using the ShowView system or the
TIMER menu, FULL appears in the display window for about five seconds.
The
indicator flashes in the display window when you complete the setting in
step 9 with no tape inserted.
If you set the clock using the Auto Clock Set function and AUTO ADJUST is set to
ON, the clock will adjust itself to the incoming time signal regardless of
adjustments made with the Dial Timer. Be sure you have set the Auto Clock Set
correctly.
The station name may not appear if the VCR does not receive station name
information signals.

To stop recording
To stop the VCR while recording, press x STOP.
To use the VCR after setting the timer
To use the VCR before a recording begins, just press ?/1. The
indicator
turns off and the VCR switches on. Remember to press ?/1 to reset the VCR
to recording standby after using the VCR.
You can also do the following tasks while the VCR is recording:

52

Basic Operations

1 Turn DIAL TIMER so that CLOCK appears in the display window.


DIAL TIMER.
2 Press
DAY appears in the display window.
3 Turn DIAL TIMER to set the day.
DIAL TIMER.
4 Press
MONTH appears in the display window.
and press DIAL TIMER to set the month, and then the year.
5 Turn
After you set the year, CLOCK appears in the display window again.
6 Turn and press DIAL TIMER to set the hour and minute.
you have finished setting the time, press DIAL TIMER to start
7 When
the clock.

The programme position or station name appears in the display


window.

Reset the counter (page 44).


Display tape information on the TV screen (page 47).
Check the timer settings (page 68).
Watch another TV programme (page 47).

continued
Recording TV programmes using the Dial Timer (SLV-SE810N/K only)

Recording TV programmes using the Dial Timer (SLV-SE810N/K only)

53

About the Demonstration Mode

Recording TV programmes using the


ShowView system

The Dial Timer function has a Demonstration Mode that allows the user, such as a
salesperson, to enter more than eight examples of timer settings when demonstrating
the use of the Dial Timer. It cancels the FULL notice which appears if eight
programmes have already been set. Do not use the Demonstration Mode for making
timer recordings. Doing so may cause the settings to be inaccurate.

(not available on SLV-SE610N/K)


The ShowView system is the feature that simplifies programming the VCR to make
timer recordings. Just enter the ShowView number listed in the TV programme guide.
The date, times, and programme position of that programme are set automatically.
You can preset a total of eight programmes, including settings made with other timer
methods.

To activate the Demonstration Mode


Press X (pause) on the VCR while turning the DIAL TIMER. DEMO
appears in the display window for a few seconds.

Before you start


Check that the VCR clock is set to the correct time and date.
Insert a tape with its safety tab in place. Make sure the tape is longer than the total recording
time.
To record from a decoder, turn it on.
Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.
Set TIMER OPTIONS to SHOWVIEW or VARIABLE in the OPTIONS-2 menu (see page
85).
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

TIMER

PLAY
OK

Press

Basic Operations

To cancel the Demonstration Mode


Turn the power off and unplug the mains lead. Although the Demonstration
Mode is cancelled, the timer settings entered while using the Demonstration
Mode will remain. Be sure to manually cancel the timer settings before you
use the Dial Timer or any other timer method after reconnecting the mains
lead (see page 68).

TIMER.

When you set TIMER OPTIONS


to VARIABLE:
The TIMER METHOD menu
appears on the TV screen. Press
M/m to select SHOWVIEW, then
press OK.

TIMER METHOD
STANDARD
SHOWVIEW

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

When you set TIMER OPTIONS


to SHOWVIEW:
The SHOWVIEW menu appears
on the TV screen.

SHOWVIEW
2 8 . 9 FRI
SHOWVIEW NO.

SET : 09
EXIT : MENU

54

continued
Recording TV programmes using the ShowView system (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

Recording TV programmes using the Dial Timer (SLV-SE810N/K only)

1-13

55

CLEAR

Press the programme number


buttons to enter the ShowView
number.
If you make a mistake, press
CLEAR and re-enter the correct
number.

2 8 . 9 FRI

To record from a decoder or other source, leave the connected


equipment switched on.

SET
: 09
CONFIRM : OK
CANCEL : CLEAR

Press OK.
PLAY

INPUT SELECT

CLEAR

PLAY
OK

The date, start and stop times,


programme position or station name,
tape speed, and VPS/PDC setting
appear on the TV screen.

To stop recording
To stop the VCR while recording, press x STOP.

TIMER
2 8 . 9 FRI
DATE
TODAY
SP / LP

TIME
19 : 00 20 : 00
SP

Daily/weekly recording
In step 4 above, press m to select the recording pattern. Each time you press
m, the indication changes as shown below. Press M to change the indication
in reverse order.

PROG.
35

VPS / PDC

OFF

LIST

TODAY t SUN-SAT (Sunday to Saturday) t MON-SAT (Monday to


Saturday) t MON-FRI (Monday to Friday) t SAT (every Saturday) .....
t MON (every Monday) t SUN (every Sunday) t 1 month later t
(dates count down) t TOMORROW t TODAY

SELECT :

SET
:
If appears in the PROG.
CANCEL : CLEAR
EXIT : MENU
(programme) column (this may
happen for local broadcasts), you
have to set the appropriate programme position manually.
Press M/m to select the desired programme position.
To record from a decoder or other source connected to one or
more of the LINE inputs, press INPUT SELECT to display the
connected line in the PROG. position.
You will only have to do this operation once for the referred
channel. The VCR will then store your setting.
If the information is incorrect, press CLEAR to cancel the setting.

If you want to change the date, tape


speed, and the VPS/PDC setting:
1 Press </, to highlight the item
you want to change.
2 Press M/m to reset it.

Timer recording with VPS/PDC signals


Some broadcast systems transmit VPS (Video Programme System) or PDC
(Programme Delivery Control) signals with their TV programmes. These
signals ensure that your timer recordings are made regardless of broadcast
delays, early starts, or broadcast interruptions (when the VPS or PDC
indicator in the display window is lit).
To use the VPS/PDC function, set VPS/PDC to ON in step 4 above. You can
also use the VPS/PDC function for a source connected to one or more of the
LINE inputs.

TIMER
2 8 . 9 FRI
DATE
TODAY
SP / LP

TIME
19 : 00 20 : 00
SP

PROG.
35

VPS / PDC

To record satellite broadcasts


If you connect a satellite tuner and the VCR, you can record satellite
programmes.

ON

LIST

SELECT :
SET
:
CANCEL : CLEAR

1 Turn on the satellite tuner.


the satellite tuner, select the satellite programme for which you want
2 On
to make a timer setting.
3 Follow steps 1 through 6 above.
the satellite tuner turned on until the VCR finishes recording the
4 Keep
satellite programme for which you have made a timer setting.

EXIT : MENU

To record the same programme


every day or the same day every
week, see Daily/weekly recording on page 57.
To use the VPS/PDC function, set VPS/PDC to ON. For details of
the VPS/PDC function, see Timer recording with VPS/PDC
signals on page 57.

56

MENU

Basic Operations

OK

The indicator appears in the display window and the VCR stands
by for recording.

SHOWVIEW NO.
1246

EXIT : MENU

Press ?/1 to turn off the VCR.

SHOWVIEW

Press MENU to exit the menu.

continued
Recording TV programmes using the ShowView system (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

Recording TV programmes using the ShowView system (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

57

To use the VCR after setting the timer

Recording TV programmes using the timer

To use the VCR before a recording begins, just press ?/1. The indicator
turns off and the VCR switches on. Remember to press ?/1 to reset the VCR
to recording standby after using the VCR.

You can preset a total of eight programmes, including settings made with other timer
methods.

You can also do the following tasks while the VCR is recording:

Reset the counter (page 44).


Display tape information on the TV screen (page 47).
Check the timer settings (page 68).
Watch another TV programme (page 47).

Before you start

Tips
To set the programme position, you can also use the PROG +/ or programme
number buttons.
To set the programme position with a two digit number, press - (tens digit)
button followed by the programme number buttons.
To set the line input video source, you can also use the PROG +/ buttons.
To set the tape speed, you can also use the SP/LP button.
When you are recording a programme in the SP mode and the remaining tape
becomes shorter than the recording time, the tape speed is automatically changed
to the LP mode. Note that some interference will appear on the picture at the point
the tape speed is changed. If you want to keep the same tape speed, set AUTO
LONG PLAY to OFF in the OPTIONS-1 menu (page 85).
To check, change, or cancel the programme setting, press </, to choose LIST,
then press OK in step 4. For details, see step 3 in Checking/changing/cancelling
timer settings (page 68).

TIMER

Press

TIMER.

For SLV-SE610N/K:
The TIMER menu appears on the
TV screen.

TIMER
2 8 . 9 FRI
DATE
TODAY
SP / LP

PLAY

TIME
: :

Basic Operations

Check that the VCR clock is set to the correct time and date.
Insert a tape with its safety tab in place. Make sure the tape is longer than the total recording
time.
To record from a decoder, turn it on.
Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.
Set TIMER OPTIONS to STANDARD or VARIABLE in the OPTIONS-2 menu (see page
85).*
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

PROG.

SP

LIST
OK

SELECT :
SET
:
CANCEL : CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

For SLV-SE710N/K, SX710N/K, and


SE810N/K:

Notes
If the VPS/PDC signal is too weak or the broadcasting station failed to transmit
VPS/PDC signals, the VCR will start recording at the set time without using the
VPS/PDC function.
The
indicator flashes in the display window when you press ?/1 with no tape
inserted.
When you set TIMER OPTIONS to STANDARD in the OPTIONS-2 menu, the
SHOWVIEW menu does not appear on the TV screen. Select SHOWVIEW or
VARIABLE.
The VPS/PDC function is automatically set to OFF for the timer recording of a
satellite programme.
The station name may not appear if the VCR does not receive station name
information signals.

When you set TIMER OPTIONS


to VARIABLE:
The TIMER METHOD menu
appears on the TV screen. Press
M/m to select STANDARD, then
press OK.

TIMER METHOD
STANDARD
SHOWVIEW

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

When you set TIMER OPTIONS


to STANDARD:
The TIMER menu appears on the
TV screen.

TIMER
2 8 . 9 FRI
DATE
TODAY
SP / LP

TIME
: :
SP

PROG.

VPS / PDC

OFF

LIST

SELECT :
SET
:
CANCEL : CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

58

continued
Recording TV programmes using the timer

Recording TV programmes using the ShowView system (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

1-14

59

PLAY
OK

INPUT SELECT

Set the date, start and stop times,


programme position or station
name*, tape speed, and VPS/PDC
function*:
1 Press , to highlight each item in
turn.

To record satellite broadcasts


If you connect a satellite tuner and the VCR, you can record satellite
programmes.

TIMER
2 8 . 9 FRI
DATE
TODAY
SP / LP

TIME
19 : 00 20 : 00
SP

PROG.
35

VPS / PDC

OFF

1 Turn on the satellite tuner.


the satellite tuner, select the satellite programme for which you want
2 On
to make a timer setting.
Follow steps 1 through 4 above.
3
the satellite tuner turned on until the VCR finishes recording the
4 Keep
satellite programme for which you have made a timer setting.

LIST

SELECT :
SET
:
CANCEL : CLEAR

2 Press M/m to set each item.

EXIT : MENU

To correct a setting, press < to return to that setting and reset.

3
4

MENU

To use the VCR after setting the timer


To use the VCR before a recording begins, just press ?/1. The indicator
turns off and the VCR switches on. Remember to press ?/1 to reset the VCR
to recording standby after using the VCR.
You can also do the following tasks while the VCR is recording:

Press MENU to exit the menu.

Press ?/1 to turn off the VCR.

Reset the counter (page 44).


Display tape information on the TV screen (page 47).
Check the timer settings (page 68).
Watch another TV programme (page 47).

Tips
To set the programme position, you can also use the PROG +/ or programme
number buttons.
To set the programme position with a two digit number, press - (tens digit)
button followed by the programme number buttons.
To set the line input video source, you can also use the PROG +/ buttons.
To set the tape speed, you can also use the SP/LP button.
When you are recording a programme in the SP mode and the remaining tape
becomes shorter than the recording time, the tape speed is automatically changed
to the LP mode. Note that some interference will appear on the picture at the point
the tape speed is changed. If you want to keep the same tape speed, set AUTO
LONG PLAY to OFF in the OPTIONS-1 menu (page 85).
Even if you set TIMER OPTIONS* to SHOWVIEW in the OPTIONS-2 menu, you
can set the timer manually. Press MENU to select TIMER, then go to step 2.
To check, change, or cancel the programme setting, press </, to choose LIST,
then press OK in step 2. For details, see step 3 in Checking/changing/cancelling
timer settings (page 68).

The indicator appears in the display window and the VCR stands
by for recording.
To record from a decoder or other source, leave the connected
equipment switched on.
To stop recording
To stop the VCR while recording, press x STOP.
Daily/weekly recording
In step 2 above, press m to select the recording pattern. Each time you press
m, the indication changes as shown below. Press M to change the indication
in reverse order.
TODAY t SUN-SAT (Sunday to Saturday) t MON-SAT (Monday to
Saturday) t MON-FRI (Monday to Friday) t SAT (every Saturday) .....
t MON (every Monday) t SUN (every Sunday) t 1 month later t
(dates count down) t TOMORROW t TODAY

60

Basic Operations

To record the same programme every day or the same day every
week, see Daily/weekly recording on page 60.
To use the VPS/PDC function*, set VPS/PDC to ON. For details
about the VPS/PDC function, see Timer recording with VPS/
PDC signals on page 57.
To record from a decoder or other source connected to one or
more of the LINE inputs, press INPUT SELECT to display the
connected line in the PROG. position.

continued
Recording TV programmes using the timer

Recording TV programmes using the timer

61

Additional Operations
Notes
When setting the timer with VPS/PDC signals, enter the start and stop times
exactly as indicated in the TV programme guide. Otherwise, the VPS/PDC
function* wont work.
If the VPS/PDC signal is too weak or the broadcasting station failed to transmit
VPS/PDC signals, the VCR will start recording at the set time without using the
VPS/PDC function*.
The
indicator flashes in the display window when you press ?/1 with no tape
inserted.
The VPS/PDC function* is automatically set to OFF for the timer recording of a
satellite programme.
The station name* may not appear if the VCR does not receive station name
information signals.

Playing/searching at various speeds


Before you start
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.
Operation
During fast-forward, hold down M FF/M. During rewind,
hold down m REW/m.

Play at high speed

During playback, press M FF or m REW on the remote


commander.
During playback, hold down M FF/M or m REW/m.
When you release the button, normal playback resumes.

Play at twice the normal


speed

During playback, press 2.

Play in slow motion

During playback, press y SLOW.

Play frame by frame

During pause, press M FF or m REW on the remote


commander. Hold down M FF or m REW to play one
frame each second.

Rewind and start play

During stop, press H (play) on the VCR while holding down


m on the VCR.

* not available on SLV-SE610N/K

Additional Operations

Playback options
View the picture during
fast-forward or rewind

To resume normal playback


Press H PLAY.

Using the shuttle ring


(SLV-SE810N/K only)

JOG
Shuttle ring

With the shuttle ring, you can


operate a variety of playback
options. There are two ways for
using the shuttle ring, normal
mode and jog mode.

62

continued
Playing/searching at various speeds

Recording TV programmes using the timer

1-15

63

To use the shuttle ring in normal mode


During playback or pause, turn the shuttle ring clockwise or anticlockwise.
Each change in the shuttle ring position changes the playback mode in the
following way.

Setting the recording duration time


After you have started recording in the normal way, you can have the VCR stop
recording automatically after a specified duration.

Pause

Before you start


Slow motion
in reverse

Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

Slow motion

1 While recording, press z REC.


The

Normal speed
in reverse

indicator appears in the display window.

Normal speed
(Initial speed)

SP

OPC

2 Press z REC repeatedly to set the duration time.

Double speed

Each press advances the time in increments of 30 minutes.

High speed in
reverse

High speed

0:30

5:30

Normal recording

6:00

The tape counter decreases minute by minute to 0:00, then the VCR stops
recording and turns off automatically.

To use the shuttle ring in jog mode


Use this mode for frame-by-frame playback.

To extend the duration


Press z REC repeatedly to set a new duration time.

Press JOG to enter the jog mode. The JOG button lights up. If you change to
the jog mode during any playback mode, playback pauses so you can see a
still picture. Each change in the shuttle ring position shifts the picture one
frame. To shift frames in reverse, turn the shuttle ring anticlockwise. The
frame shift speed depends on the speed you turn the shuttle ring.

To cancel the duration


Press z REC repeatedly until the indicator disappears and the VCR
returns to the normal recording mode.

To resume normal mode, press JOG again. The JOG button turns off.

To stop recording
To stop the VCR while recording, press x STOP.

Tip
Adjust the picture using the PROGRAM +/ buttons on the VCR if:
Streaks appear while playing in slow motion.
Bands appear at the top or bottom while pausing.
The picture shakes while pausing.
To set tracking to the centre position, press both buttons (+/) at the same time.
Notes
The sound is muted during these operations.
In the LP mode, noise may appear or there may be no colour.
If the playback mode mark doesnt appear on the TV screen, press

64

1:00

Additional Operations

Double speed
in reverse

VIDEO

Note
You cannot display the current tape time in the display window when setting the
recording duration time.

DISPLAY.

Playing/searching at various speeds

Setting the recording duration time

Recording programmes using


the Synchronized Recording
function

Synchronized Recording
(not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

65

SYNCHRO REC

Before you start...


You can set the VCR to automatically record programmes from equipment
such as a satellite tuner by connecting the equipment to the DECODER/
LINE-3 IN*1 (or DECODER/LINE-2 IN*2) connector. The connected
equipment must have a timer function for this feature to work.

Insert a tape with its safety tab in place.


Make sure the tape is longer than the total
recording time.
Set DECODER/LINE3*1 (or DECODER/
LINE2*2) to LINE3*1 (or LINE2*2) in the
OPTIONS-2 menu (see page 85).
Refer to Index to parts and controls for
button locations.

When the connected equipment turns on, the VCR also automatically turns
on and starts recording a programme from DECODER/LINE-3 IN*1 (or
DECODER/LINE-2 IN*2).

Press INPUT SELECT or PROG +/ to display L3* (or L2* ) in the


1 display
window.
the timer on the connected equipment to the time of the programme
2 Set
you want to record, then turn it off.
3 Press SP/LP to select the tape speed.
4 Hold down SYNCHRO REC for more than two seconds.
1

How to connect for Synchronized Recording


2

Connect the DECODER/LINE-3 IN* (or DECODER/LINE-2 IN* )


connector of the VCR to the TV Scart connector of the satellite tuner. Then
connect the LINE-1 (TV) connector to the TV.
Scart cable (not supplied)
Satellite tuner, etc.
DECODER/t LINE-3 IN*1
or
DECODER/t LINE-2 IN*2

The SYNCHRO indicator appears in the display window and the VCR
stands by for recording.
The VCR automatically turns on and starts recording when it receives an
input signal from the connected equipment.
The VCR automatically stops recording when the tape reaches the end or
when the connected equipment stops transmitting an input signal.

TV Scart
connector

i LINE-1 (TV)

Additional Operations

To cancel the Synchronized Recording function


Press SYNCHRO REC. The SYNCHRO indicator disappears.
To stop recording
Press x STOP while recording.
Scart cable (not supplied)

Scart (EURO-AV)

Notes
This function may not work with some types of satellite tuners.
Some TVs or other equipment with timer functions will automatically turn off if no
operation is performed within a certain amount of time. In this case, the
Synchronized Recording also stops automatically.
When the connected equipment turns on while the SYNCHRO indicator is
appeared, recording starts automatically.
If the settings for timer recording and Synchronized Recording overlap, the
programme that starts first has priority and the second programme starts recording
only after the first programme has finished.
The Auto Clock Set function does not work while the VCR stands by for
Synchronized Recording.

: Signal flow

*1 SLV-SE810N/K only
*2 SLV-SE710N/K and SX710N/K only

66

Synchronized Recording (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

Synchronized Recording (not available on SLV-SE610N/K)

1-16

67

When the timer settings overlap


The programme that starts first has priority and the second programme starts
recording only after the first programme has finished. If the programmes
start at the same time, the programme listed first in the menu has priority.

Checking/changing/cancelling timer
settings
Before you start

Programme 1

Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.


Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

Programme 2

about 20 seconds

will be cut off

1 Press ?/1 to turn on the VCR.


2 Press MENU, then press M/m to highlight LISTS and press OK.
Press M/m to highlight TIMER LIST,
3 then
press OK:

Programme 1
Programme 2

TIMER LIST

If you do not need to change or cancel


the settings, press MENU, then turn off
the VCR to return to recording standby.
Press M/m to select the setting you want
to change or cancel, then press OK.
The selected setting appears in the
TIMER menu.

19
20
10
14
6

TIME
: 00 20
: 00 21
: 00 11
: 00 15
: 30
7
:

: 00
: 00
: 30
: 00
: 00
:

2 8 . 9 FRI
VPS
PDC
PROG.
35
SP
AAB
LP
VPS
CDE
LP PDC
FGH
LP
IJK
SP

about 20 seconds will be cut off

Tip
In step 6 above, you can check the TIMER LIST by selecting LIST and pressing
OK. Press MENU to exit the TIMER LIST.

RETURN
SELECT :
SET
: OK
CANCEL : CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

TIMER
2 8 . 9 FRI
DATE
2 . 10
SP / LP

TIME
10 : 00 11 : 30
LP

PROG.
CDE

VPS / PDC

Additional Operations

If you want to change or cancel a


setting, go on to the next step.

DATE
TODAY
30 . 9
2 . 10
MON FRI
SUN
.

ON

LIST

SELECT :
SET
:
CANCEL : CLEAR
EXIT : MENU

5
6

68

To change the setting, press </, to highlight the item you want to
change, then press M/m to reset it.
To cancel the setting, press CLEAR.
Press MENU to exit the menu.
If any settings remain, turn off the VCR to return to recording standby.

Checking/changing/cancelling timer settings

Checking/changing/cancelling timer settings

69

Bilingual programmes

Recording stereo and bilingual


programmes
In ZWEITON (German stereo) system
This VCR automatically receives and records stereo and bilingual
programmes based on the ZWEITON system. When a stereo or bilingual
programme is received, the STEREO indicator appears in the display
window.

To listen to

On-screen display

Display window

Main

MAIN

STEREO

Sub

SUB

STEREO

Main and sub

MAIN/SUB

STEREO

Standard sound*

No indicator

No indicator

* Usually the main sound (monaural)

Selecting the sound during playback

To select bilingual sound while recording


Press AUDIO MONITOR to select the sound you want.

Press AUDIO MONITOR to select the sound you want.

On-screen display

Display window

To listen to

On-screen display

Display window

Main

MAIN

STEREO

Stereo/main and sub


(left and right channels)

STEREO

STEREO

Sub

SUB

STEREO

Left channel/main

LCH

STEREO

Main and sub

MAIN/SUB

STEREO

Right channel/sub

RCH

STEREO

Standard sound

No indicator

No indicator

In NICAM system
(SLV-SE610N, SE710N, SX710N, and SE810N only)

How sound is recorded on a video tape

This VCR receives and records stereo and bilingual programmes based on
the NICAM system (The NICAM indicator appears). When a stereo or
bilingual programme is received, the STEREO indicator appears in the
display window.

The VCR records sound onto two separate tracks. Hi-fi audio is recorded
onto the main track along with the picture. Monaural sound is recorded onto
the normal audio track along the edge of the tape.

To record a NICAM programme, HIFI AUDIO in the OPTIONS-1 menu


should be set to NICAM (initial setting). To check the menu setting, see
page 85 for details.
Normal audio track
(monaural)

To select the sound while recording


Press AUDIO MONITOR to select the sound you want.

On-screen display

Display window

Stereo

STEREO

STEREO

Standard sound*

No indicator

No indicator

Stereo
Usually mixed
left/right channels

Bilingual
Usually main sound

Hi-fi audio track


(main track)

Stereo programmes
To listen to

Additional Operations

To listen to

Stereo sound
(left/right channels)

Main (left channel)


Sub (right channel)

* Usually the mixed sound of left and right channels (monaural)

70

continued
Recording stereo and bilingual programmes

Recording stereo and bilingual programmes

1-17

71

Notes
To listen to playback sounds in stereo, you must use the Scart or AUDIO OUT
connections.
When you play a tape recorded in monaural, the sound is heard in monaural
regardless of the AUDIO MONITOR setting.
If the AUDIO MONITOR button does not function, check that AUDIO MIX*1 in
the OPTIONS-1 menu is set to OFF (see page 84).
If HIFI AUDIO*1 is set to STANDARD, the standard sound will be recorded on
both the hi-fi and normal audio tracks. Pressing AUDIO MONITOR will not
change the sound.

Searching using the Smart Search


function
If you record multiple programmes on a tape, you can use the Smart Search function
to see what has been recorded on your tape. You can see information such as date,
time, and programme position of the programmes recorded. You can also start
playback directly from the selected programme using the SMART SEARCH screen.
All programmes are listed on the screen, regardless of how the programme was
recorded.

*1 SLV-SE610N, SE710N, SX710N, and SE810N only

Before you start


Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

recording, press ?/1 to turn on the


1 After
VCR.
2 Press SMART SEARCH.
M/m/</, to select the programme
3 Press
you want to start viewing.

SMART SEARCH
DATE
28 . 9
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
19 : 00 20 : 00
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

1 8 0 MIN.
PROG.
35
FGH
AAB
IJK

BLANK TIME

Additional Operations

To store programme information, see Storing the programme information on page


75. If you eject the tape before storing the information, the information will be
cleared.

3 0 MIN.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
SAVE : SMART SEARCH

4 Press OK.

SMART SEARCH
1 8 0 MIN.

The VCR starts searching, and playback


starts automatically from the beginning of
the selected programme.

NOW SEARCHING

To stop searching
Press x STOP.
To exit the SMART SEARCH screen
Press MENU.

72

continued
Searching using the Smart Search function

Recording stereo and bilingual programmes

To record in a blank space


Blank space on the tape will appear as a
blank row in the SMART SEARCH screen.
Select the last blank row in step 3, then press
OK. The VCR rewinds/fast-forwards the
tape to the beginning of the blank space, then
stops. Start recording. Note that BLANK
TIME and the remaining time indication
only refers to the length of the last blank
space.

SMART SEARCH
DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

1 8 0 MIN.
PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

BLANK TIME

Storing, searching and deleting


programme information (Smart Search
Plus)

3 0 MIN.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
SAVE : SMART SEARCH

You can store programme information, such as the recording date and time, and
programme position, for a maximum of four tapes. You can select a programme and
start playback, by recalling the information directly from the Smart Search Plus
screen.

Tips
You can store information for up to 24 programmes on a single list.
While recording, you can display the SMART SEARCH screen using the SMART
SEARCH button. If you decide to stop recording, press MENU to make the
SMART SEARCH screen disappear first. Then press x STOP.
You can have the player recall the data of the last cassette used to record
programmes even after you eject the tape (page 78).

Storing the programme information

The unit will not memorize the memory bank number for each cassette. Note the
number you assigned to each cassette.
Before you start...
Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.
Refer to Index to parts and controls for button locations.

1 Insert a cassette for recording.

The VCR automatically turns on.

2 Press SMART SEARCH.

The SMART SEARCH -RECALL-screen


appears.
RECALL is highlighted and the data for
the last cassette used to record
programmes appears.

Press </, to select a memory bank


number.
Note the memory bank number on the
cassette.
To cancel the process, press SMART
SEARCH.

Recording the programme D over the programme A and B


A

SMART SEARCH -RECALLRECALL

DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

4
PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

Originally recorded programmes


B

Additional Operations

You can store programme information for a maximum of four tapes. Before recording
a programme, select a memory bank number from the list on the SMART SEARCH
screen.

Notes
You cannot use this function unless the clock is set.
Depending on the tape, the total or remaining time may not appear correctly.
If many short programmes are recorded on a tape, multiple programmes may be
included in a single block. In this case, only the latest programme information will
appear in the SMART SEARCH screen.
Blank time is measured from the end of the last recorded programme to the end of
the tape. However, if you eject the tape and then make a new recording on the
same tape, the original recorded programme(s) is displayed as a blank space.
The station name* may not appear if the VCR does not receive station name
information signals.
If you start recording a programme D from the middle of a previously recorded
programme A and into another previously recorded programme B, the Smart
Search information for the second programme B, which is recorded over, is
deleted.

73

SMART SEARCH -RECALLRECALL


DATE

2
TIME

4
PROG.

NO DATA

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

4
5 Start recording.
Press OK.

* not available on SLV-SE610N/K

74

The information about the recorded programme will be stored on the


selected memory number.
continued
Storing, searching and deleting programme information (Smart Search Plus)

Searching using the Smart Search function

1-18

75

Searching for programme information stored on the memory bank


number

To assign a memory number after recording


After recording a programme, you can store the programme information as a new
memory before ejecting the cassette. However, you cannot add the memory on the
existed memory bank number. To store the memory as additional, select the memory
bank number before.

1 Press ?/1 to turn on the VCR.


2 Press SMART SEARCH.

You can start playback of the recorded programme after call the programme
information from the four memory bank numbers.
Before you start...
Turn on your TV and set it to the video channel.

1 Insert the cassette for which you want to use the memory bank number.

SMART SEARCH
DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

1 8 0 MIN.
TIME
PROG.
14 : 00 15 : 00
FGH
AAB
20 : 00 21 : 00
IJK
6 : 30
7 : 00

The VCR automatically turns on.

2 Press SMART SEARCH.


BLANK TIME

The SMART SEARCH -RECALLscreen appears.

3 0 MIN.

RECALL

DATE
2 . 10
4 . 10

TIME
18 : 00 19 : 00
21 : 30 23 : 00

PROG.
CDE
I JK

SAVE : SMART SEARCH

Press SMART SEARCH again.


The SMART SEARCH -SAVE- screen
appears.

SMART SEARCH -SAVE2

SELECT :
SET
: OK

CANCEL

DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

EXIT : SMART SEARCH

PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

The programme information contained in


the selected memory bank number
appears.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

</, to select a memory bank


4 Press
number.
Select the memory bank number with no
information or the memory bank number
to be deleted.
To cancel the process, select CANCEL.

SMART SEARCH -SAVECANCEL

DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

4
PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

Press </, to select the memory bank


number for the inserted cassette.

When you selected wrong memory bank


number, eject the cassette and repeat
steps from step 1.
Press OK.
The selected memory bank number
appears on the SMART SEARCH screen.

SMART SEARCH -RECALLRECALL

DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

To exit the SMART SEARCH screen


Press SMART SEARCH.

4
PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
ERASE : CLEAR
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

Memory bank number


SMART SEARCH
DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

Press OK.

Additional Operations

SELECT :
SET
: OK

SMART SEARCH -RECALL-

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

1 8 0 MIN. 2
PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

BLANK TIME

3 0 MIN.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

5 Press M/m/</, to select the programme you want to start viewing.


6 Press OK.

Note
If you select a number that is already contains programmes, the old programme
information is cleared and the new programme information is stored.

The VCR starts searching, and playback starts automatically from the
beginning of the selected programme.

To stop searching
Press x STOP.

76

continued
Storing, searching and deleting programme information (Smart Search Plus)

Storing, searching and deleting programme information (Smart Search Plus)

3 Press CLEAR.

To exit the SMART SEARCH screen


Press SMART SEARCH.

The programme information is deleted.

SMART SEARCH -RECALLRECALL


DATE

Recalling the most recent programme information


Programme information that is not saved in one of the memory bank
numbers is erased when the cassette is ejected. The RECALL memory bank
will temporarily memorize the programme information of the last tape used
for recording in case that it is accidentally ejected.

2
TIME

4
PROG.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

4 Press SMART SEARCH.

The SMART SEARCH screen disappears.

Note
You cannot use or return the deleted information.

The Smart Search Plus function has a Demonstration Mode that allows the user, such
as a salesperson, to automatically display the Smart Search Plus screens.
To activate the Demonstration Mode
While the VCR is turned on, press and hold the both x (stop) and A (eject)
buttons on the VCR for a few seconds. The demonstration will start and the
four kinds of Smart Search Plus screens will be displayed repeatedly. If you
operate the VCR, the Demonstration Mode temporarily stops. After about
five minutes, the demonstration will restart.

Note
When you insert the cassette whose information does not exist on the memory
bank number, you cannot search the recorded programme.

Deleting the programme information


You can delete the programme information stored in a memory number.

Additional Operations

About the Demonstration Mode

If you want to erase the latest information in the RECALL memory bank,
press the SMART SEARCH button instead of the OK button in step 3 and
then close the SMART SEARCH screen. The new information will replace
all of the current information in the RECALL memory bank.

To cancel the Demonstration Mode


While the VCR is turned off, press and hold the both x (stop) and A (eject)
buttons on the VCR for a few seconds. You can also cancel the
Demonstration Mode if you turn the power off and unplug the mains lead.

Before you start...


Turn on your TV and the VCR.
Set the TV to the video channel.

The SMART SEARCH -RECALLscreen appears.

NO DATA

If you re-insert the cassette in step 1 that you accidentally ejected and then
select RECALL in step 3, the data for the last tape used to record
programmes appears. Press OK and the latest information will appear on the
SMART SEARCH screen. You can then add new information to this
programme list. For an explanation about viewing programme information
without using one of the memory banks, see page 73.

1 Press SMART SEARCH.

77

SMART SEARCH -RECALLRECALL


DATE
2 . 10
4 . 10

TIME
18 : 00 19 : 00
21 : 30 23 : 00

4
PROG.
CDE
IJK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

Press </, to select the memory bank


number to delete.
The programme information on the
selected memory bank number appears.
Check the information that you want to
delete.

SMART SEARCH -RECALLRECALL

DATE
29 . 9
30 . 9
1 . 10

TIME
14 : 00 15 : 00
20 : 00 21 : 00
6 : 30
7 : 00

4
PROG.
FGH
AAB
IJK

SELECT :
SET
: OK
ERASE : CLEAR
EXIT : SMART SEARCH

78

Storing, searching and deleting programme information (Smart Search Plus)

Storing, searching and deleting programme information (Smart Search Plus)

1-19

79

Searching using the index function

Adjusting the picture


Adjusting the tracking

The VCR automatically marks the tape with an index signal at the point where each
recording begins. Use these signals as references to find a specific recording.

Although the VCR automatically adjusts the


tracking when playing a tape (the
indicator flashes in the display window, then
turns off), distortion may occur if the
recording is in poor condition. In this case,
manually adjust the tracking.

1 Insert an indexed tape into the VCR.


2 Press ./> INDEX SEARCH.

To search ahead, press > INDEX


SEARCH.
To search backwards, press .
INDEX SEARCH.

INDEX
SEARCH

TRACKING

The VCR starts searching, and playback


starts automatically from that point.

About the Reality Regenerator (RR) function

To stop searching
Press x STOP.

The Reality Regenerator function automatically restores the picture to its


original quality during playback.

Notes
No index signal will be added when recording starts from recording pause.
However, an index signal will be marked if you change the programme position
during recording pause.
When you press . INDEX SEARCH, if there is nothing recorded before the
selected index signal, playback may not start exactly at the index signal.

To use the Reality Regenerator function

1 Press MENU, then select OPTIONS and press OK.


2 Press M/m to highlight OPTIONS-2, then press OK.
Press M/m to highlight RR, then press
3 OK.

Additional Operations

During playback, press PROGRAM +/ on


the VCR to display the tracking meter. The
Tracking meter
distortion should disappear as you press one
of the two buttons (the indicator lights up).
To resume automatic tracking adjustments, eject the tape and re-insert it.

OPTIONS - 2

DECODER / LINE3
TIMER OPTIONS
POWER SAVE
TV DIRECT REC
RR
RETURN

DECODER
VARIABLE
OFF
NORMAL
HIGH
OFF

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

Press M/m to set RR to NORMAL or HIGH, then press OK.


The RR indicator lights up in the display window.

5 Press MENU to return to the original screen.


To turn it off, select OFF in step 4. The RR indicator turns off in the display
window.

80

continued
Adjusting the picture

Searching using the index function

81

About the Optimum Picture Control (OPC) function


The Optimum Picture Control (OPC)
function automatically improves recording
and playback quality by adjusting the VCR to
the condition of the video heads and tape. To
maintain better picture quality, we
recommend that you set OPC to ON in the
OPTIONS-1 menu (the OPC indicator lights
up in the display window). For details, see
page 84.

Reducing the VCRs power consumption

OPTIONS - 1
OPC
EDIT
AUDIO MIX
HIFI AUDIO
AUTO LONG PLAY
TAPE LENGTH
COLOUR SYSTEM
RETURN

ON
OFF
OFF
NICAM
OFF
E1 8 0
AUTO

You can turn off the indicators in the display window when the VCR is off (standby
mode) to reduce the VCRs power consumption.

1 Press MENU, then select OPTIONS and press OK.


2 Press M/m to highlight OPTIONS-2, then press OK.
Press M/m to select POWER SAVE, then
3 press
OK.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

OPTIONS - 2

OPC playback
The OPC function automatically works on all types of tapes, including rental
tapes and tapes that were not recorded with OPC.

DECODER / LINE3
TIMER OPTIONS
POWER SAVE
TV DIRECT REC
RR
RETURN

FULL
PARTIAL
OFF

SELECT
:
CONFIRM : OK
EXIT : MENU

4 Press M/m to highlight the option, then press OK.


For SLV-SE710N/K, SX710N/K, and SE810N/K:

To deactivate the OPC function


Set OPC to OFF in the OPTIONS-1 menu. The OPC indicator in the display
window turns off.

FULL to reduce the power consumption to a minimum.


PARTIAL to reduce the power consumption.
For SLV-SE610N/K:

Tip
To set tracking to the centre position, press the PROGRAM + and buttons on the
VCR at the same time.

ON to reduce the power consumption to a minimum.

5 Press MENU to return to the original screen.

Notes
You can adjust the tracking for an NTSC-recorded tape but the tracking meter
wont be displayed.
With the Auto Long Play function on, the OPC function will work only in SP
mode. If the tape speed automatically switches from SP to LP, the OPC function
turns off. If, however, the entire programme is recorded in LP mode, the OPC
function will work.
There is a delay of about ten seconds before the VCR actually starts recording
while the VCR analyses the tape. To avoid the delay, first set the VCR to recording
pause (the OPC indicator flashes slowly) and press z REC to have the VCR
analyse the tape (the OPC indicator flashes rapidly) and return to recording pause.
After the OPC indicator stops flashing, press X PAUSE to start recording
immediately.
If you want to start recording quickly without using the OPC function, first set the
VCR to recording pause (the OPC indicator flashes slowly) and press X PAUSE
again to start recording.

82

Additional Operations

OPC recording
Whenever you insert a tape and start recording for the first time, the VCR
adjusts to the tape using the OPC function (the OPC indicator flashes
rapidly). This adjustment is retained until the tape is ejected.

DECODER

To turn on the indicators in the display window


Set POWER SAVE to OFF in step 4.
Notes
When the VCR stands by for recording, the indicators in the display window
remain lit even when POWER SAVE is set to FULL, PARTIAL, or ON.
If POWER SAVE is set to FULL*, you cannot watch or record programmes from
your Canal Plus decoder, satellite, or digital tuner during standby mode (page 86).
* not available on SLV-SE610N/K

Adjusting the picture

Reducing the VCRs power consumption

1-20

83

Changing menu options


MENU, then select OPTIONS and
1 Press
press OK.

AUTO LONG PLAY ON to change the timer recording tape speed


automatically to the LP mode when the remaining tape
length becomes shorter than the recording time. Note
that for AUTO LONG PLAY to work correctly, the
TAPE LENGTH setting must be accurate.
OFF to keep the set tape speed.

EXIT : MENU

OPTIONS - 1

OPTIONS - 2

EXIT : MENU

DECODER / LINE3
TIMER OPTIONS
POWER SAVE
TV DIRECT REC
RR
RETURN

COLOUR SYSTEM

AUTO to set the colour system automatically.


PAL to play back a tape recorded in the PAL colour
system.
MESECAM to play back a tape recorded in the
MESECAM colour system.
If you press Z EJECT or turn the VCR off, COLOUR
SYSTEM will be reset to AUTO.

SELECT :
SET
: OK
EXIT : MENU

3 Press M/m to select the option, then press OK.


4 Press M/m to change the setting, then press OK.
5 Press MENU to return to the original screen.

OPTIONS-2

Menu choices
Initial settings are indicated in bold print.

Menu option

Set this option to

DECODER/
LINE2*2

DECODER to use the DECODER/LINE-2 IN


connector as the Canal Plus decoder connector.
LINE2 to use the DECODER/LINE-2 IN connector as
the line input connector.

DECODER/
LINE3*3

DECODER to use the DECODER/LINE-3 IN


connector as the Canal Plus decoder connector.
LINE3 to use the DECODER/LINE-3 IN connector as
the line input connector.

TIMER OPTIONS*4

VARIABLE to display the TIMER METHOD menu for


selecting STANDARD or SHOWVIEW when pressing
the
TIMER button.
STANDARD to display the TIMER menu when pressing
the
TIMER button.
SHOWVIEW to display the SHOWVIEW menu when
pressing the
TIMER button.
For details, see page 55 and 59.

OPTIONS-1

84

Menu option

Set this option to

OPC

ON to switch on the OPC (Optimum Picture Control)


function and improve picture quality.
OFF to switch off OPC.

EDIT

ON to minimize picture deterioration when editing.


OFF to turn off EDIT.

AUDIO MIX

ON to listen to the hi-fi and normal audio tracks at the


same time. The AUDIO MONITOR button will not
function.
OFF to listen to the hi-fi and normal audio tracks
separately. Select the sound using the AUDIO
MONITOR button.
If you press Z EJECT, AUDIO MIX will be reset to
OFF. For details, see page 72.

E180 to use an E-180 or shorter type tape.


E195 to use an E-195 type tape.
E240 to use an E-240 type tape.
E300 to use an E-300 type tape.

TAPE LENGTH
DECODER
VARIABLE
OFF
ON
NORMAL

Additional Operations

ON
OFF
OFF
NICAM
OFF
E1 8 0
AUTO

SELECT :
SET
: OK

NICAM to record NICAM broadcasts on the hi-fi audio


track.
STANDARD to record standard sound on the hi-fi audio
track.
For details, see page 70.

OPTIONS - 1
OPTIONS - 2
RETURN

Press M/m to highlight OPTIONS-1 or OPTIONS-2, then press OK.


OPC
EDIT
AUDIO MIX
HIFI AUDIO
AUTO LONG PLAY
TAPE LENGTH
COLOUR SYSTEM
RETURN

Set this option to

HIFI AUDIO*1
OPTIONS

SELECT :
SET
: OK

Menu option

continued
Changing menu options

Changing menu options

85

Editing
Menu option

Set this option to

POWER SAVE*4

FULL to turn off the indicators in the display window


during standby mode to reduce the VCRs power
consumption to a minimum. For using the Line Through
function (page 18) or the decoder (page 39), select
PARTIAL or OFF.
PARTIAL to turn off the indicators in the display
window to conserve the VCRs power.
OFF to turn on the indicators in the display window
while the VCR is standing by.
ON to turn off the indicators in the display window
during standby mode to reduce the VCRs power
consumption to a minimum.
OFF to turn on the indicators in the display window
while the VCR is standing by.

TV DIRECT REC*4

ON to activate the TV Direct Rec function.


OFF to deactivate it.

RR

NORMAL for normal everyday use.


HIGH for well-used video tapes such as rented tapes.
Select this option when NORMAL does not improve the
picture quality.
OFF to switch off the Reality Regenerator function.

How to connect to record on this VCR


Connect the line outputs of the other VCR to the LINE IN connector or jacks
of this VCR. Refer to the examples A through C and choose the connection
that best suits your VCR.
Example A
Your VCR (Recorder)

TV

i LINE-1 (TV)
Other VCR (Player)

Editing

POWER SAVE*5

Connecting to a VCR or stereo system

Scart
(EURO-AV)

Notes
When the VCR stands by for recording, the indicators in the display window
remain lit even when POWER SAVE is set to FULL, PARTIAL or ON.
With the EDIT option ON, the OPC function does not work.

VMC-2121HG Scart cable (not supplied)

: Signal flow

*1 SLV-SE610N, SE710N, SX710N, and SE810N only


*2 SLV-SE710N/K and SX710N/K only
*3 SLV-SE810N/K only
*4 not available on SLV-SE610N/K
*5 SLV-SE610N/K only

Example B
Your VCR (Recorder)

TV

t LINE-2 L o R
(open cover to connect)
LINE OUT

VMC-820HG audio/video cable (not supplied)

Other VCR (Player)

: Signal flow

86

continued
Connecting to a VCR or stereo system

Changing menu options

1-21

87

Example C
Your VCR (Recorder)

Basic editing

TV

(when recording on this VCR)


Before you start editing
DECODER/
t LINE-3 IN*1
or
DECODER/
t LINE-2 IN*2

Turn on your TV and set it to the video


channel.
Press INPUT SELECT to display the
connected line in the display window.
Press SP/LP to select the tape speed, SP or LP.
On this VCR, set EDIT to ON in the
OPTIONS-1 menu. If the other VCR has a
similar function, turn it on as well.

Other VCR (Player)

Scart
(EURO-AV)

z REC

: Signal flow

How to connect to a stereo system


(SLV-SE810N/K only)

Editing

a source tape with its safety tab removed into the other (playback)
1 Insert
VCR. Search for the point to start playback and set it to playback pause.
a tape with its safety tab in place into this (recording) VCR.
2 Insert
Search for the point to start recording and press X (pause).
Press z REC on this VCR to set it to recording pause.
3
start editing, press the X (pause) buttons on both VCRs at the same
4 To
time.

VMC-2121HG Scart cable (not supplied)

To stop editing
Press the x (stop) buttons on both VCRs.

Connect the t LINE-2 L o R jacks on this VCR to the audio output jacks
on the stereo system, using the RK-C510HG audio cable (not supplied).

Tip
To cut out unwanted scenes while editing, press X (pause) on this VCR when an
unwanted scene begins. When it ends, press X (pause) again to resume recording.

Notes
Make sure you connect the plugs to jacks of the same colour.*1
If the other VCR is a monaural type, leave the red plugs unconnected.
If you connect this VCR to both the LINE IN and LINE OUT jacks of the other
VCR, select the input correctly to prevent a humming noise.
If the other VCR does not have a Scart (EURO-AV) connector, use the VMC2106HG cable instead and connect the cable to the line out jacks of the other VCR.
When you connect another VCR to the DECODER/LINE-3 IN*1 (or DECODER/
LINE-2 IN*2) connector, set DECODER/LINE3*1 (or DECODER/LINE2*2) to
LINE3*1 (or LINE2*2) in the OPTIONS-2 menu.

Note
If you start editing following the procedure above, the VCR wont start recording
with the OPC function. To record a tape with the OPC function, press z REC
again during recording pause in step 3 so the VCR analyses the tape. Then, press
X (pause) after the OPC indicator stops flashing to start recording. If you press X
(pause) before the OPC indicator stops flashing, the OPC function is cancelled.

*1 SLV-SE810N/K only
*2 SLV-SE710N/K and SX710N/K only

88

Connecting to a VCR or stereo system

Basic editing

Audio dubbing
(SLV-SE810N/K only)
This feature lets you record over the
normal audio track. The monaural
sound previously recorded is replaced
while the original hi-fi sound remains
unchanged. Use this feature to add
commentary to a tape that you have
recorded with a camcorder.

AUDIO DUB

t LINE-2 L o R

Before you start...


Open the t LINE-2 L o R jacks cover on the front panel and connect a playback source.
Turn on the TV and set it to the video channel.

a source tape into your stereo system (or the playback VCR).
1 Insert
Search for the point to start playback and set it to playback pause.
a prerecorded tape with its safety tab in place into this (recording)
2 Insert
VCR. Search for the start of the section to be replaced and press
X (pause).

The VCR enters pause mode.

3 Press AUDIO DUB.


4

The programme position changes to L2, and the indicator appears in


the display window.
To start editing, press the X (pause) buttons on this VCR and the stereo
system (or other VCR) at the same time.
After you use this feature, the audio in playback mode is automatically
set to monaural.

To stop editing
Press x (stop) on this VCR and the stereo system (or other VCR).
To listen to both the hi-fi and normal audio
Set AUDIO MIX to ON in the OPTIONS-1 menu (page 84). Use this feature
to listen to dubbed audio over the original hi-fi audio. When AUDIO MIX is
set to ON, the AUDIO MONITOR button does not function.
Remember to reset AUDIO MIX to OFF after playing the tape.
Note
If you eject the tape or turn the VCR off, AUDIO MIX is automatically set to OFF.

90

Audio dubbing (SLV-SE810N/K only)

1-22
1-22E

89

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 2
DISASSEMBLY
Note: Follow the disassembly procedure in the numerical order given.

2-1. UPPER CASE REMOVAL

1 Two screws
(Case3 TP2)

2-3. POWER BLOCK (SRV938EK) REMOVAL

3 Upper case

2 Connector
(CN201)
1 Connector
(CN202)

3 Three screws
(B3)

2 Two screws
(Case3 TP2)
5 Power block
(SRV938EK)
4 Claw

2-4. FRONT PANEL SECTION REMOVAL

2-2. REAR PANEL REMOVAL

5 Two claws
(EXCEPT SE610: A, G, K, N)

6 Two claws
(SE610: A, G, K, N)

8 Rear panel

4 Two claws
(EXCEPT SE610)
1 Power cord
(CN101)

7 Two claws

2 Connector (CN501)
(SE810/SX810/X9)

1 Flat cable (FDS-9/10)


(CN461)

5 Two claws

2 Harness

4 Two claws

3 Two claws

3 Two claws
6 Front panel section

2-1

2-5. MECHANISM DECK REMOVAL


3 Flat cable
(FFM-001)
2 Flexible board
4 Flat cable (FAC-8)
(ACE head)
1 Connector
8 Screw
(FE head)
7 Screw
(BVTP3 12)
(BVTP3 12)

6 Claw

0 Mechanism
deck
9 Screw
(BVTP3 12)

5 Screw
(B3)

Note: When mounting the mechanism deck,


first align mark on the rotary switch.

2-6. MA-400 BOARD REMOVAL

3 Four screws
(B3)

4 MA-400 board

2 Connector (CN201)
1 Connector
(CN202)

2-2

2-7. INTERNAL VIEWS

Drum assembly (M901) (DZH-0B5A-R)


1-772-364-11 (EXCEPT SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
Drum assembly (M901) (DZH-0B6A-R)
1-772-365-11 (SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

FE head
1-500-471-11
Q101
Tape end sensor
8-729-043-84
Q100
Tape top sensor
8-729-043-84
D100
Tape top/end LED
8-719-048-26

Drum assembly (M901) (DZH-0B5A-R)


1-772-364-11 (EXCEPT SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
Drum assembly (M901) (DZH-0B6A-R)
1-772-365-11 (SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
M902
Capstan motor
1-698-971-11

M903
Cam motor assembly
X-3947-577-1
2-3

2-8. CIRCUIT BOARDS LOCATION

MA-400
VIDEO, AUDIO, I/O,
SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL,
TUNER, MODE CONTROL

POWER BLOCK
(SRV938EK)
(POWER SUPPLY)

JK-201
(SE810/SX810/X9)
(FRONT IN)
DS-95
(MODE CONTROL)

2-4
2-4E

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 3
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
3-1. OVERALL BLOCK DIAGRAM

MA-400 BOARD (SEE PAGE 4-9 to 4-26)


EXCEPT SE610
IC201
IC162 (1/2)

(1/2)
Y/C
PROCESSOR

B
G
R

OSD

L OUT
R OUT

V IN
EXCEPT SE610: A, G, K, N

A (R) OUT
AV LINK
AV CONT

JK-201 BOARD (1/2)


(SEE PAGE 4-27)
FRONT VIDEO

V OUT

IC850

A (L) OUT

VPS/
PDC
SE610B/SE710B/SX710B/SE810B/
X9B
IC970

A (R) OUT

Q871 Q873
SAT
CIRCUIT

19
3
1
10
8

IN
AERIAL

SP
CH1
SP
CH2

EXCEPT SE610

Q VD, C ROT
IIC DATA
IIC CLK
RF SWP
RF ENV

LP
CH1
LP
CH2

D FG

DRUM
FG

M902
CAPSTAN MOTOR
CAP VS, CAP RVS

CAP FG

CAPSTAN
FG

AFT
CTL IN+, CTL IN

Q501, 502
AV
CONT

VIDEO
HEAD

DRUM
PG

TU SW1
NICAM DATA,
NICAM CLK

EXCEPT SE610

TU VIDEO

D PG

TU702/703

EXCEPT
SE610: A, G, K, N

22

AV CONT
Q800 Q804
AV
LINK

AV LINK I/O

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL

MODE1 4

AF ENV

T SENS
MOD A
AF SWP, AF REC P

S SENS
IC161

Q100
S SENS
Q102

EEPROM
T/S LED

EXCEPT
SE610: A, G, K, N

27
23

IC160

A (L)

POWER
FAIL DET
RESET
PULSE GEN

A (R)

SE810/SX810/X9

LED
DRIVE

FLD DATA, FLD CLOCK, FLD CS

FR (R)

SRV938EK BOARD

ND420

FL
DRIVER

FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR
TUBE

REC PRF

(SEE PAGE 4-33)

DS-95 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-27)

+38V
FUNC KEY 1
+13V

IC201 (2/2)
IC351
HEAD
SWITCH

T350, Q351
BIAS
ERASE
OSC

SE810/SX810/X9

FUNCTION
KEY

FUNCTION
KEY

FUNC KEY 2
FILTER

NORMAL
AUDIO
PROCESSOR

SWITCHING
REG

SW+5V
DMS +/

DUAL
MODE
SHUTTLE

D+6V
MTR+12V

JS350 EXCEPT SE810/SX810/X9

+F

T390, Q392
FULL
ERASE
OSC

FULL
ERASE
HEAD

IC420

S101
(REC PROOF)

NORMAL OUT

NORMAL IN

(SEE PAGE 4-27)


FR (L)

AUDIO
ERASE
HEAD

IC460
REMOTE
CONTROL
RECEIVER

REMOCON

FULL ERS

JK-201 BOARD
(2/2)

MONO
AUDIO
HEAD

D100
(T/S LED)

Q101
T SENS

AF SWP, AF REC P

A (R)

SW12V

PH101
S REEL

AF ENV

E2 L
E2 R

TU L
TU R
TU M

A (L)

M903
CAM
MOTOR

S REEL FG

L1 (L)
L1 (R)

CH2

PH100
T REEL

IIC DATA
IIC CLK

IC301
Hi-Fi
AUDIO
PROCESSOR

CAM+/

CAM
ENCODER

T REEL FG

SECAM ON

CH1

CAM
MOTOR
DRIVE
S100

CAM
IIC DATA
IIC CLK
RF SWP
RF ENV

CTL
HEAD
IC130

Q VD, C ROT

SECAM DET

Hi-Fi
AUDIO HEAD

TU SW2

40
24

SAT CONT

OUT

IIC DATA
IIC CLK

SECAM
PROCESSOR

D VS

X9 : B, D, E, G

V OUT
A (L) OUT

SE810/SX810/X9

M901
DRUM MOTOR

IC162 (2/2)

IIC DATA
IIC CLK

G
B

TU VIDEO
TU L
TU R
TU M

28
32
36
41

V IN
R

MOD V
MOD A

20
15
11
7

S410
DIAL TIMER

F
11V

KKP +/

SE810/SX810/X9
05

3-1

3-2

SE810/SX810/X9

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
3-2. VIDEO BLOCK DIAGRAM

MA-400 BOARD (1/5)


(SEE PAGE 4-9, 11, 15, 19)

FROM AV LINK

Q540

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

47

EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N/
SE710 : G, I/SE810G/
X9G

IC201 wg PB

CLP

49

CLP

52

CLP

54

CLP

56

CLP

58

59

CHABA
INS

6dB AMP

LPF

YNR

45

43

BUFFER
Q975, 976
SWITCH
PB-H 44

R
SYNC
SEP

Q970
4.43MHz BELL
FLTER

1H/2H
DL

INV

PIC
P CONT

IC970

96

AMP

PB

Q973

P R

Y/C
MIX

2.1 Vp-p (H)

OSD

1H
DL
CLP

CN260
(1/2)

VIDEO
HEAD

SECAM PROCESSOR
26

27

21

LPF
R

PB

SP
CH2

94

ENV
DET

R
R

89

LP
CH1

PB

C
LPF

COMP

P
AGC
AMP

BACK UP
AMP
SUB
COMV.

PB

MAIN
COMV.

SECAM
DET

DL
EQ

BPF1

BPF2

FM
AGC

HA
CONT

IC201 og REC

PB
EQ

IC201 yk REC/PB

DEM

REC
95
P

4.5 Vp-p (H)

90

74
AGC

ENV DET
C SYNC

REC
APC

VXO2

27

SYNC
GATE

REC
LIM

CONTROL
LOGIC
X200
4.433619MHz

AFC

REC
PB

TO MUTE

28

15

FILTER ADJ

2.2MHz
BPF

4.43MHz
VCO

1.1MHz
OSC

X2

REC
MUTE

REC

SYNC
GATE

1/4

PB

AGC
AMP

AGC
DET

PB

PB

REC

1.1MHz
BPF

Fo
ADJ

76

4.43MHz
BPF-B

420 mVp-p (H)

84 68

82

REC
EQ

81

FM
MOD

IC201 is REC/PB

HA SWP

REC

REC
BGA

IC201 wa REC

KIL
ATT

3.8 Vp-p (H)

16
REC/
PB

4.43MHz
BPF-A

X2

PA

17

PB
MUTE

TO PB AGC
TO REC KILLER

MODE
CTL
PB
BGA-B
PB
BGA-A

AGC
DET

Fo
ADJ

BGP
GEN

SUB
LPF

PB

REC

SUB
BUF

DOUBLE
LIM

4.43MHz
VCO

TO MUTE
TO SYNC GATE

SYNC GATE GEN/


V-SEP

91

LP
CH2

IC162 th, ya, yf REC/PB

BUFFER

IC162 (1/3)
R
P

SE810/SX810/X9

SP
CH1

: SE610 : B, E/SE710/SX710/SX717

CN480
(1/2)

: SE810/SX810/X9

DECODER/LINE 2 IN

64 C V IN

BUFFER

FBC 1/2

1 Vp-p (H)

CN501
(1/2)

OSD V 61
OUT

56 OSD V IN

Q661

25

BPF

DECODER/LINE 3 IN

Q660

65
NAP

40

VA

FRONT VIDEO

VIDEO

V OUT

REC: 360 mVp-p (H)


PB: 450 mVp-p (H)

6dB
AMP
KIL
B.D

EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N
CN570

BUFFER

(SEE PAGE 4-27)

EXCEPT SE610

IC201 rg REC/PB

460 mVp-p (H)


61

JK-201 BOARD (1/2)

LINE 2
IN

69

SERIAL
DECODER

6dB AMP

IC201 ts REC/PB

70

EXCEPT
SE610 : A, G, K, N/
SE710 : G, I/
SE810G/
X9G
Q541

IC850
VPS/PDC

Q VD

VIDEO
AGC

63
J481(1/2)

Q VD

TUNER
(SEE PAGE 3-9)

MOD V

17 CVBS
5 SDA
4 SCL

IIC DATA
IIC CLK

67
TUNER VIDEO

CN500 (1/4) : SE610: A, G, K, N


CN570 (1/4) : EXCEPT SE610: A, G, K, N

CN500/CN570
LINE 1
(TV)

VA

SE610 : B, E
/SE710/SX710/SX717

IC201 (1/2)
VIDEO INPUT SELECT
Y/C PROCESSOR
CCD DELAY

: SE810/SX810/X9
DECODER/LINE 2 IN

BUFFER

C + DET

TUNER
(SEE PAGE 3-10)

19

CA

CN570
DECODER/LINE 3 IN

V OUT

Q850

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

I CONT

B
G
R
I
C + DET
V IN

CN500 (2/4) : SE610 : A, G, K, N


CN570 (2/4) : EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N

Q510
BUFFER

TO AV LINK

EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N
28
32
36
37
29
41

2 Vp-p (H)

CA

CN500/CN570
LINE 1
(TV)

2.1 Vp-p (H)

AV CONT

Q800-804
AV
LINK

AV CONT
AV LINK
V IN
I
R
G
B

IC201 yg REC

EXCEPT SE610

Q501, 502
AV
CONT

8
10
20
16
15
11
7

IC201 yg PB

MAIN
EMPH.

N.L.
EMPH.

DETAIL
ENH

CLP

IC201 uh REC

IC201 uh PB

11

13

IC201 wj REC/PB
Q201

CN262

REC: 500 mVp-p (H)


PB: 380 mVp-p (H)

CHECK

2
5
6

IC201 us REC/PB

PB RF

21

RF SWP

RF SWP
72

COMP
OUT
83

BUFFER
C ROT
73

560 mVp-p (H)

SW 5V

620 mVp-p (H)

480 mVp-p (4.433619 MHz)

Q972

ADJ SW

Q974

CTL

BUFFER

5 Vp-p (2 V)

Q140
C ROT
RF ENV
COMP OUT

IC201 iz REC/PB
SE810/SX810/X9

HA SWP
RF SWP
CTL CHECK
ADJ SW

REC: 500 mVp-p (H)


PB: 380 mVp-p (H)

IC201 ud PB
Q977

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

SECAM ON
SECAM DET

1.7 Vp-p (2 V)
MODE CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-11)

05

3-3

3-4

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

SE610B/SE710B/SX710B
SE810B/X9B

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
3-3. SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM

MA-400 BOARD (2/5) (SEE PAGE 4-15)


MTR12V
CN101
VCC

RESET 52

P FAIL 78

5.4 Vp-p (56 kHz)

D VS

CHECK

IC160

IC162 ul REC/PB

D110

OUTPUT

CN161
RESET 4
DATA
2
CLOCK
3

IC162 (2/3)
SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL

79 DRUM ERR

OUTPUT

RESET
PULSE
GEN.
POWER
FAIL
DET.

IC162 <z/m REC/PB


IC161
HALL
DEVICE

EEPROM

MATRIX
3

4.8 Vp-p (2 V)

D PG

107 DRUM PG

PG

M901
DRUM MOTOR

FG
2

D FG

106 DRUM FG

IC162 ea REC/PB

4.2 Vp-p (360 Hz)

2.7 Vp-p (17.734475 MHz)

CAP VCC SW5V

17.734475MHz IN 31

SW5V

HALL
DEVICE

CN102
7
1
6

VM
U+
VCC
UTL
V+
VW+
W-

7
1
6

5 DATA
6 CLK

IIC DATA (EEP) 45


IIC CLK (EEP) 44

IC162 <z/n REC/PB

PS120

17.734475MHz OUT 32

LIMITER

32kHz IN 34
32kHz OUT 35

IC162 i; REC/PB

X161
17.734475MHz

X160
32.768kHz

IC162 ef REC/PB

U
5

M902
CAPSTAN
MOTOR

CAPSTAN
FG

5.4 Vp-p (56 kHz)

CAP VS

80 CAP ERR

CAP RVS

NICAM DATA 98
NICAM CLK 97

37 CAP RVS

CAP FG

104 CAP FG

4.6 Vp-p (1 kHz)

112 CTL IN +

111 CTL IN

NICAM DATA
NICAM CLK

TU SW1 67

SW1

TU SW2 92

SW2

TU AFT 8

IC162 <zzx REC

CN350 (1/2)
CTL
HEAD

1.8 Vp-p (32.768 kHz)

IC162 <z/v REC/PB

TUNER
(SEE PAGE 3-9)

TU AFT
SDA
SCL

5 Vp-p (2 V)

X9 : B, D, E, G
IC162 <zzz REC
Q871 Q873
SW12V

93 T REEL

5 Vp-p (2 V)

SAT CONT

81

CTL AMP OUT


AV CONT
TO AV LINK
FROM AV LINK

114
27
83
76

SAT
CIRCUIT

D5V
J871
STB Control
(mini jack)

PH100
T REEL
94 S REEL
PH101
S REEL
10 T SENS
D5V

Q101
T SENS

D100
(T/S LED)

9 S SENS
Q100
S SENS

IC130
CAM
MOTOR DRIVE

CN104

100
99
19
21

IIC DATA
IIC CLK
Q VD
C ROT

RF ENV
ENV S
HA SWP
RF SWP
SECAM DET
SECAM ON

11
23
22
24
103
89

RF ENV
COMP OUT
HA SWP
RF SWP
SECAM DET
SECAM ON

S101
(REC PROOF)

IC162 wa, wf REC/PB

5.3 Vp-p (2 V)

IN2 4
S100
(CAM ENCODER)
MODE
SWITCH
MECHA
POSITION

46 CAM

10 CAM+
MODE1
MODE2
MODE3
MODE4

42
41
40
39

MODE1
MODE2
MODE3
MODE4

VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-3, 4)

IIC DATA
IIC CLK

43 REC PRF

2 CAM-

1
3

26 END LED

I CONT
C+ DET

SDA (VI/HF/TU/ARC/MOD/VPS)
SCL (VI/HF/TU/ARC/MOD/VPS)
Q VD
C ROT

Q102
LED
DRIVE

M903
CAM
MOTOR

I CONT 38
AV CONT IN/C+DET 71

CTL CHECK
AV CONT
TO AV LINK
FROM AV LINK

A MUTE
AF ENV
AF SWP
AF REC P
FULL ERS

74
12
25
28
29

A MUTE
AF ENV
AF SWP
AF REC P
FULL ERS

AUDIO
(SEE PAGE 3-8)

05

3-5

3-6

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
3-4. AUDIO BLOCK DIAGRAM
MA-400 BOARD (3/5) (SEE PAGE 4-9, 17, 19)
TUNER
(SEE PAGE 3-9)

MOD A

EXCEPT SE610

IC301

Hi-Fi AUDIO
PROCESSOR

R
13
MUTE

CN500 (4/4) : SE610 : A, G, K, N


CN570 (4/4) : EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N

14

Q591

16
AUDIO
HEAD

CN260 (2/2)
9

OUTPUT
SEL

37

CH1

VCO
H
36

10

PNR
L
MUTE

BRF
L

CH2

VCO
35

11

MUTE

PNR
R

MUTE

15

Q590

17

MUTE

LINE 1
(TV)

18

CN570

19

24

DECODER/LINE 3 IN

20

22

DECODER/LINE 2 IN

: SE810/SX810/X9

SE610 : B, E/SE710/SX710/SX717
EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N

Q592
LEVEL
DET

MUTE
CONTROL

NORMAL IN

INPUT SEL

22

A MUTE

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

NORMAL OUT
4

21

SCL
SDA

CHECK

CN262
HF ADJ

44 43 42

TUNER
(SEE PAGE 3-10)

2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

TUNER L
TUNER R
TUNER M

CN350 (2/2)
4
IC351
HEAD
SWITCH

AUDIO
REC/PB
HEAD
2

3
AUDIO
ERASE
HEAD

1
T350,
Q351

BIAS
SWITCH

JS350
T390, Q392

CN351

FULL
ERASE
HEAD

Q390, 391 PS390

FULL
ERASE
JS351 OSC

C+12V

PB

SE810/SX810/X9

EQ

14

18
LP/SP

JK-201 BOARD (2/2)

LINE 2 IN
AUDIO

L
R

CN480
(2/2)

FA (L)
FA (R)

SW1

CN501
(2/2)
3

PB/EE

LINE 1
(TV)

A (L)
10

MUTE

1 HD-SW CTL

CN500/CN570

LINE
AMP

PB
17
16

(SEE PAGE 4-27)


J481(2/2)

19
PB

SE810/SX810/X9

A (R)

REC
AUTO
BIAS

12

VREF

REC

11

REC : EP/LP
PB : EP
13

IC201 (2/2)
NORMAL AUDIO
PROCESSOR

CN570
DECODER/LINE 3 IN

27

: SE810/SX810/X9
23

DECODER/LINE 2 IN

A (L)
A (R)
IIC DATA
IIC CLK
AF ENV

: SE610 : B, E/SE710/SX710/SX717
EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N
CN500 (3/4)
: SE610 : A, G, K, N
CN570 (3/4)
: EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, K, N

AF SWP
AF REC P
FULL ERS

05

3-7

3-8

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

99

EXCEPT SE810/
SX810/X9

Q352

BIAS
ERASE
OSC

CN500/CN570

41 AF SWP

J500
AUDIO
OUT

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
3-5. TUNER BLOCK DIAGRAM

MA-400 BOARD (4/5)


(SEE PAGE 4-21)

IN
TU702

AERIAL

SDA
SCL

M OUT
R OUT
L OUT

3 5

12 11

19 20 23

28 29

21 27 26 24

V OUT

SW1
SW2
AFT

MOD A

SDA
SCL

AUDIO
(SEE PAGE 3-8)

6 2

SDA
SCL

MOD V

MOD A

VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-4)

MOD V

OUT

TUNER VIDEO

VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-3)

TUNER L
SDA
TUNER R

SCL

AUDIO
(SEE PAGE 3-7)

NICAM DAT
SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-6)

NICAM CLK

SW1
SW2

EXCEPT SE610G/SE710G/SE810G/X9G
R733

TUNER M

R731

3 5

12 11

19 20 23

29 30

21 28 27 24

SDA

SDA
SCL

SW1
SW2
AFT

SDA
SCL

M OUT
R OUT
L OUT
V OUT

SCL

2 6

MOD A
MOD V

TU AFT

IN
AERIAL
OUT

TU703

SE610 : E, N/SE710 : E, N, I/SE810 : E, N/SX710 : E, N/SX717E/X9E

05

3-9

3-10

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
3-6. MODE CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM

MA-400 BOARD (5/5)


(SEE PAGE 4-15, 23)

IC162 (3/3)

IC420

MODE CONTROL

FL DRIVER

FLD DATA 88
FLD CLOCK 86
FLD CS 90

7 D IN
8 CLK
9 CS

IC460

ND420
S1

S16

S17

14

29

31

G6

G1

37

42

FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR
TUBE

DS-95 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-27)

REMOTE CONTROL
RECEIVER

REMOCON 77

SE810/SX810/X9

SE810/SX810/X9

OUT

D5V

CN450
1
2
4
5

D450
JOG
CN460
JOG LED CONT 72

DMS+ 65
DMS 66
FU KEY2 13

6
5
7
8

KKP 18
KKP+ 17
FU KEY1 14

S478

S477

SYNCHRO
REC

AUTO SET UP/


RF CHANNEL

JOG LED CONT

DMS+
DMS
A/D2 GO
A/D2 RTN

Q450
LED
DRIVE

CN451
9

PLAY
STOP
DUAL MODE
SHUTTLE

6
7
5
4

S476
PROGRAM

1
2
9
10

EXCEPT SE610

KKP
KKP+
A/D1 RTN
A/D1 GO

11
10
3
2

SE810/SX810/X9

S460

CN461
4
3

A/D1 GO
A/D1 RTN

S457

S450

REC
z

S451

CN453

S410
DIAL TIMER

2
3

PUSH/TURN

S464
AUDIO
DUB

S463

SE810/SX810/X9

ADJ SW

PROGRAM
+

2
1

A/D2 RTN
A/D2 GO

KKP
KKP+
KKP SW

4
5
S452
STOP

S453
PLAY

VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-4)

S455

S454
JOG
SE810/SX810/X9

EXCEPT SE810/SX810/X9

05

3-11

DMS1
DMS2
STOP
PLAY

3-12

S456

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
3-7. POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM

MA-400 BOARD

TU702/TU703
30V
30V
BB (5V)
5V
5V
5V

MB (5V)

(SEE PAGE 4-9 to 4-26)

7 16 1 14 25 26

TU703

SRV938EK BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-33)

D301

Q303-306

3
D307

D252
CN101
F101

L101-103

D101-104

LINE
FILTER

RECT

Q151
SWITCHING
REG

CAPSTAN VCC

D304

12
POWER
TRANS

13

+13V

SW+12V

12

13V

22 VCC

SWITCH

IC162

D750

C+12V REG

L201

L975

SW5V

Q751, 752

SW5V CONT

4
IC601

D302

SWITCH
AC IN

CAPSTAN VCC

12V

C+12V

SERVO/SYSTEM
CONTROL

L701

SWITCH

SWITCH

CN600

CN201

Q301, 302, 307

IC970
SECAM PROCESSOR

L751

D251

L750

T151

Q720, 721

SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B

16
91
75
82

CONT
4

Q612, 613
SWITCH

13

MODE CONT
SW5V CONT
MTR12V CONT
11V CONT

DS-95 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-35)
SE810/SX810/X9

L662
D253

SW5V CONT

PS201

L202

14
PS202

55 OSD VCC

Q205
SW 5V
REG

15
16

D+6V
SW+5V
SW+5V

D606

15

Q206

SWITCH

OSD VCC

2
JS603

SWITCH
PC151

Q201, 204

PHOTO
INTERRUPTER

L204
L201
L202
L351
L203
L281

EXCEPT SE610 : A, G, N, K
5

SWITCH

6
9
10
11

MTR+12V
MTR+12V
P CONT M24V
P CONT M18V
P CONT M12V

5
6

PS602

Q607, 608
C+5V
SWITCH

L140

71
24
42
3
50
93

Y VCC
C VCC
CCD VCC
A VCC
ALWAYS 5V
H.A VCC

8
D450
JOG

115 AMP VCC

VIDEO INPUT SELECT


Y/C PROCESSOR
NORMAL AUDIO PROCESSOR
CCD DELAY

Q203

D254

33 VCC
116 AVCC

IC201

SE610 : A, G, N, K

16

CN460 D5V CN451

D607 L160

14

87 18V CONT
5 24V CONT
IC160
5 VCC2
L161

RESET
PULSE
GEN.

IC460
REMOTE CONTROL
RECEIVER

POWER
7 VCC1 FAIL
DET.

VCC

D603
84

10
8 VCC

11

C+/SW12V CONT
(C+5V CONT)

L460

IC161
EEPROM

IC420
FL DRIVER
13 VDD
43 VDD
30 VEE

D5V
11V

IC351
HEAD SWITCH

IC850

IC301
VCC

EXCEPT
SE610

VPS/PDC

Hi-Fi AUDIO
PROCESSOR
JS301

ND420
FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR TUBE

19 VDD D
20 VDD A

34 VCC 12V

F+

L301

40 VCC 5V

PS120
D100
(T/S LED)

1
2
PS251

11V CONT
38V

CAPSTAN VCC

1
2

SWITCH

3
4
6

+F
F

D110

4
6
CN601

05

3-13

M902
CAPSTAN
MOTOR

8 VCC1
9 VCC2

Q207, 210, 211


11V

IC130
CAM
MOTOR DRIVE

PH100,101
T/S
REEL

CN202

CN102
SW 5V

3-14 E

CN101
MTR 12V

M901
DRUM
MOTOR

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 4
PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
For schematic Diagram:
Caution when replacing chip parts.
New parts must be attached after removal of chip.
Be careful not to heat the minus side of tantalum capacitor,
because it is damaged by the heat.
All resistors are in ohms, 1/4 W (Chip resistors : 1/10 W) unless otherwise specified.
k : 1000 , MW : 1000 k.
All capacitors are in F unless otherwise noted. pF : F
50V or less are not indicated except for electrolytics and
tantalums.
All variable and adjustable resistors have characteristic curve
B, unless otherwise noted.
2 : nonflammable resistor.
5 : fusible resistor.
C : panel designation.

f
: internal component.
C : adjustment for repair.
U : B+ Line.
V : B Line.
Circled numbers refer to waveforms.
Voltages are dc between measurement point.
Readings are taken with a color-bar signal input.
Readings are taken with a digital multimeter (DC 10 MW).
Voltage variations may be noted due to normal production
tolerances.

THIS NOTE IS COMMON FOR PRINTED WIRING


BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS.
(In addition to this, the necessary note is printed
in each block.)
For printed wiring board:
X : indicates a lead wire mounted on the component
side.
x : indicates a lead wire mounted on the printed side.
b : Pattern from the side which enables seeing.
(The other layers patterns are not indicated.)

Note: The components identified by mark 0 or dotted line


with mark 0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.
When indicating parts by reference
number, please include the board
name.

4-1

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
4-1. FRAME SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM

CN101
2P
AC IN

AC IN

AN GND

CN260
11P

18

OSD VCC

LP CH2 F

17

CAPSTAN VCC

LP CH1,2 S

16

CAPSTAN VCC

15

MTR 12V

14

MTR 12V

SP CH1,2 S

13

MTR GND

SP CH1 F

12

MTR GND

GND(SW)

11

P CONT M24V T

FE
AUDIO CH1 H

MA-400 BOARD

CN480
5P

AN GND
FRONT AU(L) IN

AU GND

FRONT AU(R) IN

SP CH1,2 S

SP CH1 F

GND(SW)

FE

AUDIO REC

13V

12

11

AUDIO CH2 L

SW12V T

13

D6V

14

SW5V

15

SW5V

16

AN GND

17

AN GND

18

AUDIO CH1 H

AUDIO REC

10

AUDIO CH2 L

11

LP
CH2
LP
CH1
SP
CH2
SP
CH1
AUDIO
CH1
AUDIO
CH2

FAC-9

CN350
7P
7

CTL(X)

CTL(X)

CTL(Y)

CTL(Y)

CTL HEAD

19

-11V CONT

38V

-11V

+F

D GND

-F

D GND

CN161
4P

CHECK

FRONT VIDEO IN

GND(AU)

GND(AU)

A HEAD PB

A HEAD(X)

A HEAD REC

A HEAD(Y)

CLOCK

GND(AU)

DATA

A ERASE HEAD

D GND

CN262
6P

CHECK

RESET

GND(AU)

A ERASE HEAD

4
3

RF SWP

PB RF

AUDIO
ERASE
HEAD

FE HEAD

N.C.

FULL ERASE(X)

GND(AU)

FULL ERASE(Y)

GND

AUDIO
REC/PB
HEAD

FE-124

CN351
3P

HF ADJ

CN501
5P

FRONT VIDEO IN

FR-82

LP CH1 F
SP CH2 F

10

ADJ SW

LP CH1 F
SP CH2 F

11

CTL

JK-201
BOARD

10

AC IN

SE810/SX810/X9

DRUM

LP CH1,2 S

P CONT M18V T

AN GND

11

P CONT M12V

10

LP CH2 F

CN601
7P

19

10

CN600
19P

CN600
19P

POWER
BLOCK
(SRV938EK)

FULL
ERASE
HEAD

FFM-001

CN101
5P

AN GND

MTR 12V

MTR 12V

FRONT AU(L) IN

D VS

D VS

AU GND

D PG

D PG

FRONT AU(R) IN

D FG

D FG

MTR GND

MTR GND

M901
DRUM
MOTOR

SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717

FDS-8

CN461
5P

CN453
5P

DS-95 BOARD

A/D2 RTN

A/D2 RTN

A/D1 RTN

A/D1 RTN

A/D1 GO

A/D1 GO

D GND

D GND

FDS-7

11
CN450
5P

PLAY

PLAY

STOP

COM

DMS 2

DMS 1

10

STOP
DUAL MODE
SHUTTLE

JOG LED CONT

D5V

H
05

KKP+

KKP+

CN460
11P
KKP-

KKP-

D5V

A/D2 RTN

A/D2 RTN

A/D1 RTN

A/D1 RTN

4
3
2

A/D1 GO

DGND

CAM(+)

M903
CAM
MOTOR

CN102
9P
1

SW 5V

CAP RVS

CAP FG

CTL-REF

CAP VS

LIMITTER

CAPSTAN VCC

MTR GND

AN GND

6
7

A/D2 GO

A/D2 GO

N.C.

2
3

DMS+

DMS+

CAM(-)

JOG LED CONT

DMS-

DMS-

CN451
11P
SE810/SX810/X9

A/D2 GO

A/D2 GO

CN104
3P

M902
CAPSTAN
MOTOR

A/D1 GO

10

DGND

11

SE810/SX810/X9

FRAME
4-3

4-4

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

There are a few cases that the part isn't mounted in this model is printed on this diagram.

4-2. PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS


MA-400 (VIDEO, AUDIO, I/O, SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL, TUNER, MODE CONTROL) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

SE610 : A, G, K, N
SE810/SX810/X9
EXCEPT SE610 : B, E/SE710/SX710/SX717

4-5

VIDEO, AUDIO, I/O, SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL, TUNER, MODE CONTROL


MA-400

4-6

MA-400 BOARD
CN101
CN102
CN104
CN161
CN260
CN262
CN350
CN461
CN460
CN500
CN501
CN570
CN600
CN601

B-3
E-2
H-4
I-11
B-9
A-5
A-6
J-1
I-1
A-11
J-12
B-11
G-1
I-1

D100
D110
D424
D500
D501
D502
D503
D504
D570
D571
D572
D573
D590
D603
D606
D607
D702
D720
D721
D750
D800
D871
D872
D873

F-6
C-2
I-13
B-10
B-12
A-11
A-11
A-12
B-11
A-12
A-11
A-5
D-9
C-2
I-2
I-11
C-13
D-12
D-12
I-13
G-6
A-3
A-2
A-2

IC130
IC160
IC161
IC162
IC201
IC301
IC351
IC420
IC460
IC601
IC850
IC970

H-4
H-11
I-12
H-9
C-7
C-9
A-7
I-6
J-4
I-12
G-13
C-4

Q100
Q101
Q102
Q140
Q201
Q202
Q351
Q352
Q390
Q391
Q392
Q501
Q502
Q510
Q540
Q541
Q590
Q591
Q592
Q607
Q608
Q612
Q613
Q660
Q661
Q720
Q721
Q751
Q752
Q800
Q801
Q802
Q803
Q804
Q850
Q871
Q872
Q873
Q970
Q972
Q973
Q974
Q975
Q976
Q977

F-10
F-1
F-5
H-7
C-6
D-7
B-7
B-7
E-10
E-10
E-10
C-11
D-11
C-11
C-11
D-11
D-10
D-10
D-10
C-2
C-2
J-12
I-12
F-8
F-9
D-12
C-12
C-12
B-12
G-6
G-6
G-6
G-6
G-6
H-12
A-2
B-2
A-2
D-4
D-4
D-4
D-4
D-3
D-4
D-4

MA-400
VIDEO, AUDIO, I/O,
SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL,
TUNER, MODE CONTROL

POWER BLOCK
(SRV938EK)
(POWER SUPPLY)

JK-201
(SE810/SX810/X9)
(FRONT IN)
DS-95
(MODE CONTROL)

4-7

Waveforms
1 IC201 og REC

3.8 Vp-p (H)

2 IC201 wa REC

420 mVp-p (H)

3 IC201 wg PB

460 mVp-p (H)

4 IC201 wj REC/PB

480 mVp-p (4.433619 MHz)


5 IC201 rg REC/PB

REC : 360 mVp-p (H)


PB : 450 mVp-p (H)

6 IC201 ts REC/PB

1 Vp-p (H)

7 IC201 yg REC

qa IC201 ud PB

1.7 Vp-p (2 V)

qs IC201 uh REC

2 Vp-p (H)

8 IC201 yg PB

560 mVp-p (H)

qd IC201 uh PB

2.1 Vp-p (H)

9 IC201 yk REC/PB

4.5 Vp-p (H)


0 IC201 us REC/PB

5 Vp-p (2 V)

4-8

620 mVp-p (H)

qf IC201 ia REC/PB

REC : 500 mVp-p (H)


PB : 380 mVp-p (H)
qg IC201 is REC/PB

REC : 500 mVp-p (H)


PB : 380 mVp-p (H)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (VIDEO, AUDIO) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series
1

12

11

10

13

14

15

16

17

19

18

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
R:REC MODE
P:PB MODE

CTLCHK

RF_ENV
ENV_SW

JL203

C295
0.01u

6P

D[1]

JL206

L355
0

JL355

47p
C250

R232 C243
0.1u
47

L253 47nH
NC

26

27

28

29

30

50
49
48
47
46

C221
0.1u

45

SECAM_VIDEO
L202
10uH

5.1

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-13)

C215
47u
16V

C214
0.01u

C217
0.1u

9.5

C218
0.01u

1.9

38

B+

44
43
42
41

DECVOUT

C220
10u
50V

39

40

D[0]

C213
1u
50V

R205
3900

37
36

L1VOUT

C252
47p

C219
1u 50V

3.6

C212
0.01u

C211
0.01u

0.6

34

35

D[1]

REC_C
PB_C
FSC

33

2.3

PB3V

32

C201
22u
50V

SECAM_VIDEO

B+

4.9

C_SYNC

MA-400 BOARD (2/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-12)

SW5V
ANGND

B01

B+

25

NC

23

REC APC FILT

22

X OUT

21

2.1

20

3
MA-400 BOARD (5/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-19)

DECVIN

47p

C222 L251
1u
47nH
50V

31

1.8

AGC TC1

VIDEO IN3 LINE2

2.2

VIDEO IN4 DECODER

FBC

C226
0.47u 16V

L254 47nH

C244
0.1u

C251 47p

C245
0.033u

R233
47

L255
47nH

1.3

JL208

2.3

AGC TC2

VIDEO IN5

1.8

C230
0.1u

2.9

VPS OUT

REG 4V

R2.1/P0

VIDEO AGC IN

JL210

4.1

L1 VOUT

19

X IN

18

ACC DET

17

PB SECAM IN

15

C-VCC

14

C359
*

R354
180

L356
0

C351
22u
50V

C390
0.047u

C358 C357
0.1u 47u
16V

R0.7/
P0

L357
0

L362
0

C370
47u
Q352
BIAS SWITCH 16V

L361
0
C361

4.7u

C368
10u
50V
R359
270

SECAM_ON

B02

SECAM_DET

5.1

R362
6800
C375
0.01u

SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/
SX710B/X9B

C242
1u
50V

PB_RF

2.8

R203
1800

JL215

1.5

C202
0.047u

Q201
2PD601AR-115
BUFFER

3.4

X200
4.433619MHz

JL202

C204
1u
50V

R239
0

24

L201
10uH

C365
1200p

R370
820

R360 R361
330k 10k

3.3

L358
0
C367
0.01u

3.3

16

C203
0.022u

13

JL201

12

R357 R358
1200 18k

L360
0
JL354

1.8

REG2 BIAS

JL211

JL213

R220
100

4.4

2.2

2.5

QVD

Y-GND

VIDEO LINE OUT

C-SYNC

1.9

JL212
SERIAL CLOCK IN

V-VCC

SERIAL DATA IN

5.1

0.4

C232
0.1u

JL219

RF SWP

R2.8/P2

R221
0

2.5

C248 16V
47u

R219
100

R218
100

R206
470

R207
470

L204
10uH

18k

47k
R208

47k

10k

R209

R210
HA SWP

AUDIO MUTE/C ROT

C363
33u
16V

11

R201
1800

L353
0

*C359
0.047u:SE610/SE710/
SX710/SX717
0.018u:SE810/SX810/X9

10

FRONTVIN

D[2]

R200
0

TU_VIDEO_IN

B+

C209
0.022u

C210
1u
50V

R202
1k

C207
0.01u

SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/
SX710B/X9B

C206
47u
16V

7
AD1

50V

MA-400 BOARD (6/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-21)

B+

D[3]

C223
0.1u

L1VIN
C249

R204
8200

C205
0.1u

CTL(Y)
CTL(X)

X1 OUT

B+

B+

CTL
HEAD

R240
0

5.1

C369
1u 50V

R0.3/P3.4

5.1

SLD FILT

AFC/APC FILT

3
PB FM OUT/
SECAM C IN

NC

X1 IN

Q352
2SC1815GR-TPE2

GND (AU)

R211

2.3

LINE OUT

JL352
JL353

AGC2 TC2/BALANCER FILT

L351
100uH

A HEAD PB

FBC1

ALC DET2

2.3

C362
22u
50V

B+

R2/P1.7

SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/
SX710B/X9B

A HEAD REC

NC
PAL/MESEC DET FILT

SP HFL

AUDIO
REC/PB
HEAD

P/S AFC FILT

SP CH1(+)

JL351
1

GND (AU)

MAIN DEEMPHA OUT

FM AGC

R4.4/P2.1

C-GND

99

NC

SP CH1.2(-)

T350

7P
AERASE HEAD

VCO

SP CH2(+)

R3.4/P0.2
7

CN350
AUDIO
ERASE
HEAD

NC
CCD GND

H.A.VCC

L352
100uH

B+

CCD VCC

R4.4/P2.1

R231
47

L252
47nH

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-14)

CTL_X

L203
10uH

JL214

CCD Y IN

RD

C225
47u
16V

5.2

JL356

C355
47u
16V

JS351
0

R351
47

R352
*

C354
0.01u

SE810/SX810/X9

C353
0.01u

R2.5/
P5.1

2.1

HA PRE GND

AUDIO PB IN

96

R353
1

JS350

JL362

100

2
FE HEAD

EXCEPT SE810/SX810/X9

ALWAYS 5V
VIDEO IN2 LINE1

R4.4/P2.1

CTL_Y

IC201
LA71710M-MPB

FULL
ERASE
HEAD

R2.3/P5.1

GND (AU)

3P

CN351

R290
0

C288
0.01u

Q351
2SD1620-TD
BIAS ERASE OSC

97

R284
680

98

*R352
3.9k:SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717
5.6k:SE810/SX810/X9

PB3V
C224
0.01u

2.1

R3.2/P2.3

95

C298
10p
C299
10p

EP CH2(+)

EQ NFB

AUDIO CH2

EP CH1.2(-)

0.8

SECAM_DET

51

VIDEO INPUT SELECT


Y/C PROCESSOR
NORMAL AUDIO PROCESSOR
CCD DELAY

2.3

C286
0.1u

52

IC201

EP CH1(+)

0.8

A.GND

L281
100uH

94

0.8

EQ IN

91

B+

53

2.4

2.3

B+

AUDIO CH1

92

C285
47u 16V

54

EP HFL

EQ SW1

C297
10p

A3

55

R2.6/P2.3

A2

56

SE610:B,E/SE710:B,D,E,K,N/
SE810:B,D,E,K,N/SX710/SX717/
SX810/X9:B,D,E,N

7 8

C366
1500p

11

57

2.7

AUTO BIAS IN

10

AUDIO CH2 L

58

PB H

R0.5/P0.1

AUDIO REC

11

R289
0
C296
10p

59

CCD Y OUT

R2.6/P2.3

10

R283
680
A1

60

R1.3/P3.9

AUDIO REC OUT

61

SECAM_ON

B02

REC FM AGC2 FILT

AUTO BIAS OUT

AUDIO CH1 H

62

FULLERS
B01

REC FM AGC2 REF

R2.6/P2.3

FE

63

R1.8/P0

R2.3/P5.1

C284
0.01u

JL286

66

R1.4/P0

AUTO BIAS

67

C229
10u
50V

3.2

R0.7/P0

GND(SW)

68

C247
47u
16V
65
64

IICCLK

2.4

NC

SP CH1 F

69

10

Vref 2.3V

83

JL204

C282
0.022u

JL285

70

IICDAT

JL361

FBC2

2.3

JL284

71

C228
1u
10V

B+
SE810/SX810/X9

VCA DET

AUDIO IN2

JL283

11

72

C227
10u
50V

VIDEO IN1 TUNER

ALC DET

73

2.3

SP CH1,2 S

74

JL360

SP CH2 F

HA GND

NC

R282
2700

ENV DET

C233
47u
16V

12 13

15

A-VCC

R0/P3.1
C281
0.22u

COMP OUT

NC

SP CH1

LP CH1 F

C395
0.1u

JL282

87

JL281

88

1
2

89

LP CH2 F
LP CH1,2 S

0.3

90

1
2

C293
100p
R281
6800

75

REC HA IN/PB HA OUT

84

11P

93

CN260

REC EQ OUT/
PB EQ IN

76

R2.5/P2.3

85

R228
0

86

82

JL218

SP CH2

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)

FROM_OSD_VIDEO

(SEE PAGE 4-13)

C231
0.1u

77

AD HD-SW CTL

81

LP CH1

R0.4/P1.6

14
R2.7/
P3.1

78
AGC2 TC1

79

LP CH2

C240
0.01u

C236 C241
1u
220p 50V

L205
100uH

JL205

80

VIDEO PEAKING

R1.4/P1.7

R2.5/P1.6

C239
0.1u

R216
0

R1/P0.8

C237
1u
50V

MAIN EMPH

JL217

R2.3/P2.7

CTL

JL216

R217
2700

C238
27p

B+

HF ADJ

JL209

5.1

CHECK
ADJ SW

TO_OSD_VIDEO

4.4

R3.1/P2.3

REG 2.5V

GND

A_MUTE

RF_SWP
Q202
2PB709AR
-115

B+

DEC VOUT

EQ OUT

RF SWP

HA_SWP

D[3]

C.ROT

R214
6800

EQ SW2

D[2]

SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/
SX810/X9

JL207

2.3

PB RF

R212
1800

L359
0

CN262

C234
150p

D[0]

QVD

MA-400 BOARD (7/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-23)

B+
T390

B+
8

Q392
2SC4040TL2-Q
FULL ERASE
OSC

R0.4/
P0.3

JL357

C393
100u
16V

PS390
0.25A

R0.1/
P11.9
R5.1/
P0

C394
100p

JL253

C+12V

ANGND

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-26)

B+

5.1

ANGND

VIDEO SIGNAL
R3.4/P0.2

0
1

LINE_OUT
R369
56k

LINE_IN

HEAD SWITCH
7

6
R356
18k

Q391
PDTC144EK-115
SWITCH

CHROMA

C352
4.7u
50V

IC351
8

B+

SIGNAL PATH

R355
12k

IC351
BA7755AF-E2

R-0.3/
P0.3

R11.5/P0

R391
12

11.9

L390
1.2mH

B+

C+5V

SW5V

Q390
UN2115-QRS(TX)
SWITCH

R11.8/
P0.3

R390
27k
C392
1500p

B+

R392
10k

7
1

C391
0.01u

B+

B+

JS398

JL252

C374
0.1u

2.5

A3
A2
A1

9
MA-400 BOARD (4/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-17)

Y/CHROMA

AUDIO
SIGNAL

REC
PB

AUDIO_CH2
AUDIO_REC

REC

AUDIO_CH1

AFENV

REC/PB

PB

Ref.signal

SE810/SX810/X9
05

Note: The components identified by mark 0 or dotted line


with mark 0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

VIDEO, AUDIO
4-9

4-10

MA-400 (1/8)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

MA-400 (SECAM) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM


Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.

11

10

MA-400 BOARD (2/8)


A

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
R:REC MODE
P:PB MODE

SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B
C_SYNC
SECAM_DET

SECAM_VIDEO
Q970
2PB709AR-115
4.43MHz BELL
FILTER

L975
10uH

B+

2.1

2.5

17

16

15

PB-OUT

PB-H

REC-IN

IC970

L973
47uH

SECAM PROCESSOR
C988
100p

REG

PB-IN

AGC FILTER

2.6

REC-OUT

0.8

5.1

C993
0.01u

PB_C

Q973
2PD601AR-115
BUFFER
R994
39k

R0.8/
P0

C983
0.001u

R969
6800

C985
100p

R990
0
C987
0.47u
50V

R999
0

R0.8/P0

5600

R985
470

REC_C
FSC

5.1

SIGNAL PATH

R3.2/
P2.3
Q974
2PD601AR-115
R996 BUFFER
39k

VIDEO SIGNAL
CHROMA

Y/CHROMA

REC

C986
10u 50V

SECAM

MA-400 (2/8)

4-11

R0.5/
P1.5

ANGND

R3.1/
P2

PB

05

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-10)

R0.3/
P1.2

C996
10p

JL973

JL974

IREF1

4.4

VREF1

C992
0.01u

R1.5/
P1.2

SECAM_ON

Q977
PDTC144EK-115
SWITCH

R983

27uH

680p
C982

R989
1k

5
Q972
PDTA114EK-115
SWITCH

PB_RF

R988
15k

L972
47uH

R993
33k

JL975

C991
0.1u

47k

47k
R977

R986

220p
C976

L971

0.1
JL971

JL970
2700

2.7

1.1MHz BELL

14

2.3

GND

13

2.6

1.1MHz OFFSET

12

2.6

4.3MHz OFFSET

11

0.1

BGP TIMING

10

0.4

AFC FILTER

R975
0

R5.1/P0.1

R0.4/P5.1

R981
27k

100k
R980

2.6

18
LIM EXC

VCC

19
IREF4

S/H C1

20
VREF4

S/H C2

2.8

0.022u

R997
10k

2.8

C974
1u
50V

C995
100u
16V

5.1

B+

C975

C973

C981
0.01u

R976

0.01u

C980
0.1u

R995
33k

C984
0.01u

R5.1/
P0.1

PB3V

R974
22k

R998
10k

Q976
PDTC144EK-115
SWITCH

R972
27k

21

Q975
PDTA114EK-115
SWITCH

R0.4/P5.1

3.6

2
R973
220k

C994
0.01u

CLK IN

MODE
1

C977

8200
10k
R979

DET C

2.6

22

R2/
P5.1

2.6

4.3MHz BELL

23

SECAM-DET
OUT

5.1
24

5.1

R982
47k

R978

C979

L970

R968 150k
25

SYNC-IN

2.7

0.1

0.4

26

R1.5/P1.2

LA7337

27

IC970

28
SYNC GATE
TIMING

0.3

JL972

R971
33k

6.8uH

R3/P2.6
R3/P2.6

C971
R970
33k

150p

C972
4700p

2.2u
C970
220p

2.6

B+
SW5V

0.01u

C978
4700p

50V

4-12

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series
4

12

11

10

13

14

15

16

VIDEO SIGNAL
SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

REC

VPS/PDC

MTR12V
MTRGND
CAPSTANVCC

DATA

B+

2.5

CAP VS

LIMITTER

CAPSTAN VCC

MTR GND

AN GND

B+

C121
0.01u

JL127

JL129

C123
0.01u

Q804
PDTC144EK-115

C114
0.01u

C113
0.01u

C115
0.1u

SS086

SS106

JL115

CN101

TUSW2
IICCLK

14
MA-400 BOARD (6/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-21)

IICDAT
MODCONT
TUAFT
NICAMCLK
NICAMDAT
PCONT_SW5V

SS107

JL114
JL113

SS079
R114
47k
C108
1u

B+

C107
47u
16V

JL112

R115
47k

5P

MTR GND

D.FG

D.PG

D.VS

MTR 12V

JL111

M901
DRUM
MOTOR

SS081
D110
MPG06D-6052PKG3

SS080
SS079
R184
0

SS078

B+

R103
22k

SS077

SS072

D100
GL528V1
(T/S LED)

(AX)

(AX)

R106
39

R107
39

C105
0.001u

R105
2200

SS010
S100
(CAM ENCODER)

SS066
R100
15k

SS065
JL117

2.4
C100
0.001u
JL118

S101

PH100
GP3S120S
(T REEL)

JL116

(REC PROOF)

JL106

JL105

SS094

JL103

R669
100

JL100

C671
22p

B+

R666
0

R145 0

C101
0.001u

B+

PH101
GP3S120S
(S REEL)
3
1

JL101

R102
15k

JL104

SS043

1.1

B+

C670
1u

C669
3900p

R101
470

1.1

R663
1500

JL142

JL109

5.1
C103
330u
6.3V

0.4

SS026

6
SS067

5.1

R108
22k

Q101
PT380F3
T SENS

JL102

R196
3300

C102
0.001u

Q100
PT380F3
S SENS

SS071

5
5
5
1.9
0.1
2
1.9

B+

SS074
R187
JW

Q102 1.8
2SC1815GRTPE2
LED DRIVE

R104 JL107
1k

5.1

SS009

SS075

JL108

(RA)

SS076

SS041
SS040
SS039
R667
330

R672 1k

CAM MOTOR DRIVE


IC130
LB1943N

CAM(+)

0.2

VCC 2

13.3

VCC 1

V REF

6.3

4.8

VCH

VCL

IN2

Q660
2PB709AR-115
BUFFER

IC130
IN1

R668 100

C666
560p

CAM(-)

R662
470

R661
1M

2.7

0.1u

10

B+
L663
22uH

B+
C133
0.1u

C672
0.01u

C667
0.01u

R133
47k

R130
15k

SS046

1.9

C668
100u
16V

R671
0

JL130

JS130

C134
0.1u
C131
47u
16V

JL169

B+

L662
22uH

JL131

B+

B+

B+

CN104

3P

CAM(-)

CAM(+)

CAM(+)

JL133

B+

M
M903
CAM
MOTOR

X9:B,D,E,G
SS067
SS092
SS099
SS100

B+

*IC161
M24C32-WMN6T(A):X9:B,D,E,G
M24C16-WMN6T(A):SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9N

B+

L871
10uH

B+

5.1
5.1

SIGNAL PATH

R871
4700

SS016
SS008

REC

REC/PB

PB

SS098

Drum speed servo

SS091

D873
PDZ6.8B-115

C871
0.01u

C873
0.1u

R872
220k

5.1

4.8

R876
10

JL871

4.7
D871
PDZ6.8B-115

Q873
2PD601AR-115

J871

R875
1k

SS097
C872
47u
16V

Q872
2SD999-T1CL
R874
1k

Q871
2PD601AR-115
BUFFER

SS081

Drum phase servo

R873
2200

JL872
STB Control
(mini Jack)
Q872,873
SWITCH

C874
0.1u

C875
470u
6.3V

D872
PDZ6.8B-115
CN161

Drum servo(speed and phase)

DGND
TUSW1

M902
CAPSTAN
MOTOR

R805
10k

MTR(GND)

JL660

5.2
1.9

B+

B+

CTL-REF

JL128

B+

OSD_W_LEVEL

OSD_GND

OSD_V_IN

OSD_VCC

LP

OSD_LPF

1.3

JL162

Q802
2PD601AR-115

C801
0.01u
59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87

TO_FLD_DATA

FLD_CS

SACAM_ON

TU_SW2

SW5V_CONT

N.C.

T_REEL

S_REEL

N.C.

NICAM_CLK
N.C.

2.4
OSC_CHARA(IN)
2.4
OSC_CHARA(OUT)
4.8
RESET

JL662

5.1

D800
1SS119-25TD

4.4

4.4
4.6
NICAM_DATA

N.C.

SCL(VI/HF/TU/ARC/MOD/VPS)

SDA(VI/HF/TU/ARC/MOD/VPS)

N.C.

CAP_FG

SECAM_DET

AMP_VSS

DRUM_FG

DRUM_PG

AMP_VREF_IN

AMP_VREF_OUT

B+

SS083

R186
0

R175
0
R172
0
R190
3300
R191
3300
R179

R181
3300

470

2.5
2.5
0.3

2.3
0.1

R177 470

R178 470

22u

N.C.

CTL_IN-

B+

CAP FG

4
JL125

SS082

SE610:B,K,N/
SE710:B,K,N/
SE810:B,K,N/
SX710:B,K,N/
X9:B,N
C665
L661
56p
22uH

Q661
2PB709AR-115
BUFFER

R170
3300

JL168

IC161

B+

2.5

SS056

B+

C164
100u
16V

C120
0.01u

B+

JL160

B+

R121 47k

SS076

SS083

0 JL199
0
5.1

R670
470

JL661

C162
0.22
5.5V

R120 47k

SS080

SS084

B+

JL161

CAP RVS

3
JL124

SS087

0
5
0
2.7
2.7
5
5
5.1
5
0

SW 5V

SS042

C170
0.1u

C165
0.01u

L160
22uH

SS108

C122
47u
16V

R804 R806
10k
10k

JL122

SS093

R664
0

SS055

B+

R185
0

JL146 R146
0

C664

R171
10k

4700

9P

B+

CLK

R660
1k

C661
15p
C167
0.047u
C662
4700p
C663
0.01u

R189
1k

0 0 0

5.1

B+

SS088

SS089

SS090

SS092

SS093

SS091

SS094

SS097

SS098

SS099

SS100

R183
220

SS103

SS106

SS104

SS107

50V
3
4
5

R168
150k

4.8
5.1

EEPROM
ANGND

5
5.1

B+

5.1

CLK_SEL

30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58

SS046

SW5V

FULL_ERS

MDO

SS043

SW12V

W.ENA

SS084

B+

OSDVCC

5.1

OSD_V_OUT

AF_REC_P

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-10)

JL123

B+

SS091

C+/SW12VCONT

HLF(SLICER_LPF)

C166
0.01u

SS082

-11VCONT

SS075

PCONT_M12V

PCONT_SW5V

D5V_BACKUP

SS005

PCONT_M24V

END_LED
AV_CONT

R169
470k

C163
0.01u
IC161

SS087

PCONT_M18V

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-26)

VCC 2

SS066

DMS-

D5V

OUT 2

SS065

DMS+

13

VCC 1

SS018
SS077

REMOCON

SS017

KKP-

OUT 1

KKP+

SS013

(SEE PAGE 4-23)

OSD_SECAM_C_IN

MM1256XF-BE

FUKEY2

IC160

SS014

MA-400 BOARD (7/8)

C_V_IN(C_SYNC_IN)

AF_SWP

L161
22uH

B+

SS086

12

FUKEY1

RF_SWP

POWER FAILDET
RESET PULSE
GENERATOR

SS088

FLDSCLK

DMS+

IC160

SS090

FLDCS
FLDSDA

ENV_S

N.C.

SS072

JOG_LED_CONT

DMS-

B+

HA_SW

L660
2.2uH

B+

TU_SW1

C660
15p

SS024

RF_SWP

CROT

N.C.

SS022

HA_SWP

DIV_CLK_OUT/JOGLED_CONT

N.C.

CAM

SS029

TA_MUTE

DEC/VTR

IIC_DAT1(EEP)

SS028

A_MUTE

PDC_DAV

IIC_CLK1(EEP)

SS027

SS114
CTLCHK

MTR12V_CONT

N.C.

REC_PRF

JW

SS026

FROM_AV_LINK

QVD

MODE1

R192

SS025

REMOCON

MODE2

SS024

P_FAIL

5.1
5.1
5.1
5.1
2.2

SS023

SAT_CONT

DRUM_ERR

SS042

SS023

ENV_SW

SS022

N.C.
C+5V_CONT

KKP-

SS041

SS011

RF_ENV

2.5
0
0.3
R2.1/P2.9
R2.5/P2.8
2.4
5.1
R0/P5.1
R5/P0

SS021

FLD_CLOCK

JL121

R124 470

5.1

R803
22k R802
10k

R123

SS037

R801
10k

4.6

Q803
2PD601AR-115

0
4.9

R813
10k

CN102

B+

SS104

5
5

PS120
0.4A

5.1

AV_CONT_IN/C+DET

MODE3

SS029

FULLERS

R162
10k

R800
150k

4.9

KKP+

SS040

SS089

SECAM_ON

18V_CONT

IC162
M37970MGA-050GP:SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
M37970MGA-051GP:SE610

MOD_CONT

MODE4

SS103

5.1
0
5.1
0

POWER_KEY

I_CONT

SS019

QVD

* * 5 5

-11V_CONT

IC162

CAP_RVS

C.ROT

R807
33k

TO_AV_LINK

SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL,
OSD,MODE CONTROL

5.1
5.1

SS021

SECAM_DET

SS019

FU_KEY1

SS039

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-10)

SS018

SS056

SS074

A_MUTE

SS099

R165
3300
R166
3300
R167
6800

SS055

FROM_OSD_VIDEO

11 5

CTL_X
C146
2200p
CTL_Y

FU_KEY2

SS038

IICCLK
TO_OSD_VIDEO

SS016
SS017

AF_ENV

SS037

SS100

10

R143
4700

Q800
2PB709AR-115

B+

CAP_ERR

RF_ENV

Q800-804
AV LINK CIRCUIT

R180
6800

12

*R161
1.5k:SE610E/SE710:B,G/SX710B
3.3k:SE610N/SE710:E,I/SE810B/SX710E/SX717E
5.6k:SE710N/SE810:E,G/SX710N/X9B
8.2k:SE710:D,K/SX710:D,K/SX717D
12k:SE810:D,N/SX810/X9:G,N
18k:SE810K/X9D
33k:SE610K/X9E

TEST

PB3V
IICDAT

R188
JW

T_SENS

VSS

SS014

CTL_IN+

AMP_VCC

AVCC
1

SS013

SECAM_VIDEO

R194
1k

C174
0.1u
C160
0.01u
C161
0.01u

R193 100k

SS012

AVLINK

S_SENS

1.3
17.734475MHz(IN)
1.4
17.734475MHz(OUT)
5.1
VCC
0.9
32KHz(IN)

AVCONT

SS011

TU_AFT

JL164

SS027

DEST2

JL165

SS010

B+

4
MA-400 BOARD (1/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-10)

SS009

SS071

DEST1

C171
12p

(SEE PAGE 4-19)

SS038

R182
220

*R160
1.5k:SE610G/SE710G,I/SE810G/X9G
3.3k:SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B
5.6k:SE610:K,N/SE710:K,N/SE810:K,N/SX710:K,N/X9N
0:SE610:A,E/SE710:D,E/SE810:D,E/SX710:D,E/
SX717/SX810/X9:D,E

MA-400 BOARD (5/8)

C+DET

R161
*

SS078

ICONT

11

24V_CONT

R164
10k

SS008

0
JL166
1.2
JL167
1.8
0.2
5.1
5.1
R0/P3.1
R0.1/P3.5
5.1
4.5

R160
*

R163
10k

SS028

AFRECP

N.C.

JL141

SS074

A_MUTE

N.C.

JL145

R195
0

SS005

SS099

IICCLK

B+

SS100

IICDAT

(SEE PAGE 4-17)

N.C.

JL144

29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10

SS025

14 13

10
MA-400 BOARD (4/8)

N.C.

SS012

AFSWP

B+

116 115 114 113 112 111 110 109 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88

D
AFENV

SS108

JL140

5.1

SE810/SX810/X9

32KHz(OUT)

VSSA

1.5

VSSD

VDDA

C147
0.1u

Q140
2PD601AR-115
SWITCH

JL143
X160
32.768kHz

VDDD

C173
680p

C168
15p
C169
27p

N.C.

AMPC

SCL

N.C.

R0.3/
P0.6

SS099

C143

CVBS

C142
0.022u

R1.2/P1

2.6
2.6
2.5
2.3

SDA

R141
10k

IREF

R140
10k

SS100

SS114

10
7
6

CTL_AMP_OUT

5.1
C850
0.1u

R2.6/P1.6

C144 C145
22u 100u
50V 16V

100

5.1

B+

CS

C141
0.01u

C172
10p

R856
100k

VCS

R176

C140
100u
16V

R2.5/P0

X161
17.734475MHz
JL163

JL852

VCO 1

N.C.

PD 2

B+

1.5

N.C.

DAVN

L140
22uH

11

R857
6800
R859
1.2M

12

C852
2200p

R861
680k

R142
1200

5.1

C855
0.22u

13

C856
0.1u

Q850
2PB709AR-115
BUFFER

PD 1

14

R862
2200

EHB

R2.6/P1.6

15

R860
1.2M

PB

TI

17

2.8

R858
6800

16

C853
0.033u

18

2.1

19

R852
22k

20

R853
1k

B+

IC850
SDA5650X-GEG

R851
15k

R850
100

C851
10u
50V

Y/CHROMA

SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

IC850

2.2

*:IMPOSSIBLE TO MEASURE THE


VOLTAGE AT THE MARKED POINTS.

Q801
2PD601AR-115

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
R:REC MODE
P:PB MODE

19

18

SIGNAL PATH

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


A

17

R132
470

0.2

See page 4-5 for printed wiring board and page 4-15 for waveforms.

RESET

CLOCK

DATA

D GND

4P

CHECK

Capstan speed servo


Capstan servo(speed and phase)
05

Ref.signal

Note: The components identified by mark 0 or dotted line


with mark 0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL
4-13

4-14

MA-400 (3/8)

Waveforms
1 IC162 wa REC/PB

5.3 Vp-p (2 V)

2 IC162 wf REC/PB

5.3 Vp-p (2 V)

3 IC162 ea REC/PB

2.7 Vp-p (17.734475 MHz)


4 IC162 ef REC/PB

1.8 Vp-p (32.768 kHz)


5 IC162 th REC/PB

2.1 Vp-p (H)

6 IC162 ya REC/PB

2.1 Vp-p (H)

7 IC162 yf REC/PB

2.1 Vp-p (H)

8 IC162 ul REC/PB

5.4 Vp-p (56 kHz)


9 IC162 i; REC/PB

5.4 Vp-p (56 kHz)


0 IC162 <z/v REC/PB

4.6 Vp-p (1 kHz)

4-15

qa IC162 <z/n REC/PB

4.2 Vp-p (360 Hz)

qs IC162 <z/m REC/PB

4.8 Vp-p (2 V)

qd IC162 <zzz REC

5 Vp-p (2 V)
qf IC162 <zzx REC

5 Vp-p (2 V)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (Hi-Fi AUDIO) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

10

11

12

MA-400 BOARD (4/8)

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
R:REC MODE
P:PB MODE
SIGNAL PATH
C315
8200p
R311
2200
R312
27k

JL304

R305
1k
C306
47u
16V

3.9

VCC 5V

L1 OUT L

AF SWP

MUTE

SDA

MUTE

SCL

RF OUT

AF ENV

ALC

22
21
20
19
18

EMPHL

DCL

GND

IREF

3.9

0.8

3.8

3.9

0.8

VREF

DETL

L1 OUT R

IC301
TDA9605H/N2,518

4.6
C338
10u
50V
C337
10u
50V

6.1
6.1

R315
220

0
6.1
C319
10u
50V
C320
10u
50V

6.1
0
0

C336
10u
50V

3.9
0

C322
10u
50V

L3 R

L3 L

L1 R

R316
220

11

3.8

10

3.8

R325
18k

3.8

R310
18k

3.8

R309
18k

L1 L

L2 R

L2 L
4

3.8

B+
C+12V

SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/
R326 SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
18k

3.8

3.8

JS301

JL305

JL312
JL313

SW5V

B+
C332
1u 50V
C333
1u
50V

C330
1u 50V
C331
1u
50V

C325
0.22u
16V
C326
0.22u
16V
C327
0.22u
16V

JL314
C328
1u 50V
C329
1u
50V

15

DETR

VSS D

C317
0.22u
16V

3.8

R313
3.3M

L301
100uH

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-26)

MUTE

Hi-Fi AUDIO PROCESSOR

C307
47u
16V

EMPHR

IC301

HM SW

R324
4700

JL325

L2 OUT L

TU R

R322
0

A_MUTE

R0.1/P3.5

PB IN1

3.8

AFENV

JL303

R304
1k

L2 OUT R

R323
4700

IICCLK

JL302

SE610:B,E/SE710:B,D,E,K,N/
SE810:B,D,E,K,N/SX710/SX717/
SX810/X9:B,D,E,N

REC OUT

TU L

(SEE PAGE 4-13)

R0.7/P4.2

3.9
23

NA OUT

JL308

IICDAT

R301
10k

24

PB IN2

TU M

10
MA-400 BOARD (3/8)

JL301

B+

25

NA IN

3.8

AFRECP

JL300

43

AFSWP

C303
0.1u

R302
18k

39

R329
470

AFENV

26

17

ANGND

27

16

R4.2/P0

28

15

C324
0.01u

29

14

R4.3/P0.6

30

VCC 12V

JL307

AUDIO_CH1

JL324

31

13

C323
0.1u

R4.2/P0.6

40

AUDIO_REC

JL323

41

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-10)

35

AUDIO_CH2

36

R4.3/P0.6

JL322

37

LINE_OUT

38

11.9

B+

42

C304
0.01u

JL310

44

LINE_IN

34

JL311

32

DCFBR

33

DCR

3.9

PB

3.9

3.9

REC

12

R306
27k

C316
10u
50V

DCFBL

R307
2200

JL309

C310 C311 C312 R308 C313 C314


47u 10u 2.2u 39k 10u 47u
50V 16V
16V 50V 50V

JL306

C309
8200p

C308
10u
50V

AUDIO
SIGNAL

JL315
JL316
JL317
JL318

TU_M

16
MA-400 BOARD (6/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-21)

JL319
TU_L
JL320
TU_R
JL321

SE810/SX810/X9

MOD_A

DEC_R_OUT
DEC_L_OUT
LINE_R_OUT
DEC_R_IN
DEC_L_IN

17

LINE_R_IN

MA-400 BOARD (5/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-19)

LINE_L_IN
FRONT_R_IN
FRONT_L_IN
LINE_L_OUT

JL326

ANGND

Q590
2PD601AR-115
MUTE

Q591
2PD601AR-115
MUTE

Q592
2PB709AR-115
MUTE CONTROL

-0.3

0.3
R591
1k

05

-0.3
R590
1k

R592
1k

JS591
0

D590
1SS119-25TD

Hi-Fi AUDIO
4-17

4-18

MA-400 (4/8)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (I/O) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

MA-400 BOARD (5/8)

R543
150

B+

11

12

14

13

R541
100

18

ANGND

SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

R2.2/
P2.9

D501
BZA408B-115

R1.5/
P2.2

1
2
3

6
5
4
SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

C+12V

R548
75

B+

Q540
2PB709AR-115
SWITCH

DECVIN

DECVOUT

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-10)

L1VIN

D571
PDZ6.8B-115

SW GND

37

36

35

SW GND

34
C580
0.01u

SW GND

33

R570
470

C570
390p

N.C.

32

R545
33k

SIGNAL PATH
VIDEO SIGNAL
Y/CHROMA

AUDIO
SIGNAL

4
5
6

R546
47k

R571
470

C571
390p

3
2
1

SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

R572
470

REC
D570
BZA408B-115

PB

C572
390p

R574
100k

C573
390p

R575
100k

E
L510
100uH

B+

SE610:B,E/SE710:B,D,E,K,N/
SE810:B,D,E,K,N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9:B,D,E,N

R573
470

31

N.C.

30

SW GND

29

C+DET

28

27

A(L) IN

26

SW GND

25

A GND

24

A(L) OUT

23

A(R) IN

22

A(R) OUT

B+

MODV

C511
47u
16V

C512
47u 16V

11.8

C510
0.01u

R0.3/
P11.8

AVLINK
ICONT

D504
PDZ6.8B-115

R0/P5.1
Q501,502
AV CONT

R11.8/P0

Q501
PDTA114EK-115

C+DET

R516
4700

R512
68

Q510
2PB709AR-115
BUFFER

R514
330

R11.8/
P3.9
11

2.6

1.9

D503

PDZ6.8B-115

UDZ-TE-17-13B

G
R500
470
C500
390p

DEC_L_IN
DEC_R_IN

DEC_R_OUT

MA-400 BOARD (4/8)

R502
470

LINE_R_IN
LINE_L_OUT
C502
390p

LINE_R_OUT
FRONT_L_IN
1
2
3

FRONT_R_IN

R503
470

6
5
4
C503
390p

D500
BZA408B-115

SE810/SX810/X9
CN501

5P

D573
PDZ6.8B-115
SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

JL543

FRONT VIDEO IN
JK-201 BOARD
CN480

AN GND

FRONT AU(L) IN

AU GND

FRONT AU(R) IN

SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

JL544

C514
33p

JL545

R509
4700

C516
4700p

J500

2P
L

(SEE PAGE 4-27)

AUDIO

JS504

JL521

LINE-2
OUT

J
C515
33p

R518
4700

JL522

05

I/O

MA-400 (5/8)

4-19

SW GND

17

SW GND

16

15

14

SW GND

13

SW GND

12

N.C.

11

10

AV_LINC

SW GND

AV CONT

A(L) IN

SW GND

A GND

A(L) OUT

A(R) IN

A(R) OUT

CN500

C501
390p

LINE_L_IN

(SEE PAGE 4-18)

V OUT

18

LINE-1(TV)

SE610:A,G,K,N

R501
470

DEC_L_OUT

17

19

AVCONT

ANGND

V IN

Q502
PDTC144EK-115

R515
1k

D502

SW GND

20
JL540

R511
150
C513
470u
6.3V

21

DECODER/LINE-2IN
:EXCEPT SE610:B,E/
SE710/SX710/SX717

JL541
R517
75

R510
180

19
MA-400 BOARD (6/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-21)

D572
UDZ-TE-17-13B

DECODER/LINE-3IN
:SE810/SX810/X9

21

SW GND

38

20

V OUT

39

V IN

40

41

21

SW GND

20

SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

FRONTVIN

R549
68

5
R0.2/
P0.4

R547
1k

L1VOUT

R0.2/
P0.4

21P X2

CN570
42
JL542

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-13)

16

SE610:B,E/SE710:B,D,E,K,N/SE810:B,D,E,K,N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9:B,D,E,N

Q541
2PB709AR-115
BUFFER

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-26)

15

R542
180

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
R:REC MODE
P:PB MODE

10

UPPER

LOWER

4-20

21P

21

SW GND

20

V IN

19

V OUT

18

SW GND

17

SW GND

16

15

14

SW GND

13

SW GND

12

N.C.

11

10

AV_LINC

SW GND

AV CONT

A(L) IN

SW GND

A GND

A(L) OUT

A(R) IN

A(R) OUT

LINE-1(TV)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (TUNER) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.

10

TU702
BTF-3WU604:SE610G/SE710G/SE810G/X9G
BTF-3WC446:SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B
BTF-3WC429:SE610:A,K/SE710:D,K/SE810:D,K/SX710:D,K/SX717D/SX810/X9D
BTF-3WC428:SE610:E,N/SE710:E,N,I/SE810:E,N/SX710:E,N/SX717E/X9E

MA-400 BOARD (6/8)

11

12

14

13

15

SE610:E,N/SE710:E,N,I,/SE810:E,N/SX710:E,N/SX717E/X9E
TU703

BTF-2WC421

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE

10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18

19 20 21 22 23 24 25

N.C.

SCL

SDA

5V

5V

V OUT

AFT

SIF

M OUT

SW2

SW1

IF

IF

N.C.

30V

RF AGC

N.C.

30V

5V

MOD V

N.C.

SCL

SDA

MB(5V)

SCL

SDA

N.C.

MOD A

26 27 28 29 30 31

R730
470

B+

B+

R732 470

R705
220

B+

B+

B+

JL710

25 26 27 28 29 30

BB(5V)

N.C.

SCL

SDA

5V

19 20 21 22 23 24

10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18

OUT

JL709

AFT

V OUT

AERIAL

SIF

M OUT

SW2

SW1

IF

TP

30V

N.C.

5V

N.C.

N.C.

RF AGC

SDA

30V

SCL

MOD V

N.C.

SCL

JL705

MB(5V)

B+

R755
100

PB

B+

REC

SDA

Y/CHROMA

OUT

AUDIO
SIGNAL

MOD A

VIDEO SIGNAL

IN

AERIAL

BB(5V)

IN

SIGNAL PATH

C
B+

R704
100
R754
100

B+

MODV

B+

MA-400 BOARD (5/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-19)

B+

19

B+

B+

C710
22u
50V

B+

6
MA-400 BOARD (1/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-10)

TU_VIDEO_IN

C712
39p

B+

C713
39p

JS702

R736
0
C711
47u
16V

B+

B+
ANGND

20
MA-400 BOARD (8/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-26)

B+

B+

B+

SW30V
SW5V

B+

B+

B+

B+

B+

D6V

NICAMDAT
NICAMCLK

Q752
2PB709AR-115
SWITCH

B+

R731 470

TUSW2

B+

TUSW1
R733 470

14

IICCLK

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-13)

IICDAT

B+

B+

4.8

R756
10k

EXCEPT
SE610G/SE710G/
SE810G/X9G

4.1
R757
1k

MODCONT

Q751
PDTC144EK-115
SWITCH

TUAFT

16
MA-400 BOARD (4/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-17)

R702
0

TU_M
C731
10u 50V

5.1
36.9
32.5

Q720
2SA1309A-QRSTA
+30V REG

C720
0.01u

D721
1SS119-25TD

TU_R

D720
1SS119-25TD

TU_L
C730
10u
50V

C755
0.1u

JS754

L750
2.2uH

B+

JL701

R713
100

B+
D702
MTZJ-T-77-33

Q721
PDTC144EK-115
+30V REG

D750
MPG06D-6052PKG3

L701
2.2uH

R724
47k

C754
470u
6.3V

B+

36.3
B+

MOD_A

R723
100

B+

C701
10u
50V

B+

B+

PCONT_SW5V

L751
10uH

C704
10u
50V

C757
0.01u

JL700

C705
0.01u

R714
470k

C708
47u
16V

C709
0.01u

C714
47u
16V

ET700
C752
100u
16V

C702
2200p

C753
0.1u

GND
05

TUNER

4-21

4-22

MA-400 (6/8)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (MODE CONTROL) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

10

11

12

13

MA-400 BOARD (7/8)


A

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
*:IMPOSSIBLE TO MEASURE THE
VOLTAGE AT THE MARKED POINTS.

-9.6

35

34

G5

G6

G7

G8

G9

-9.6

36

G4

-9.6

-9.6

37

20

21

22

JL425
JL426
JL427

C420
47u
16V

B+

*
*
*
*

30
29

-3.1

B+

JL428
JL429
JL430
JL431

SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717
CN461

C423
0.01u

B-

B-

DS-95 BOARD
CN453
(SEE PAGE 4-27)

A/D2 RTN

A/D1 RTN

A/D1 GO

D GND

B+
R460
10k

B+

R461
330

R465
3300

R466
4700

R467
6800

R468
15k

JL460
JL463

JL464

S460

S464

AUDIO
DUB

R470
10k

S463
R471
330

SE810/SX810/X9

D424
STZ6.8N-T146

PROGRAM+

H
7
MA-400 BOARD (1/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-10)

R464
47k
AD1
R477
6800

JL476

R478
15k

R479
47k

JL477

JL478
S478
SYNCHRO
REC

I
05

S476

S477

PROGRAM-

AUTO SET UP/


RF CHANNEL

SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

MODE CONTROL
MA-400 (7/8)

C424
10u
50V

5P
A/D2 GO

4-23

19

11

18

G3
G4
G5
G6
N.C.

30 29

DGND

17

3.2

B-

10

S9

A/D1 GO

S8

16

-5.2

A/D1 RTN

S7

S6

A/D2 RTN

15

-5.2

14

-5.2

A/D2 GO

S5

13

-1.1

DMS+

S4

DS-95 BOARD
CN451
(SEE PAGE 4-27)

S3

DMS-

12

-11.6

JL423
JL424

-11.6

D5V

S2

-9.5

JOG LED CONT

S1

VDD

KKP+

JL433

5.1

B+

KKP-

VSS

JL432

-1.1

11P

CN460

G2

S10

G1

9.4

B-

KEY2

FF-

KKP-

BB-

S11

-11.8

KEY1

-11.7

27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10

S12

ND420
FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR
TUBE

B-

33
32

CS

28

S13

27

CLK

26

S14

25

DIN

S15

IC420
UPD16315GB-3BS

31

1
2
3

DOUT

11

KKP+

R420
0

SE810/SX810/X9

S16

4.9

4.4

JOG_LED_CONT

IC420

24

DMS+
DMS-

OSC

VEE

23

1.9

LED4

FL DRIVER

R421
0

FUKEY2

S17

R423
82k

C427
220u
6.3V

R422
0

FUKEY1

LED3

FLDSDA

FLDCS

S18

LED2

G10

10

VCC

FLDSCLK

38

LED1(IRDREC)

R427
47

B+

REMOCON

GND

OUT

B+

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-13)

39

L460
47uH

ANGND

12

40

IC460
SFH5110-40

DGND

41

G3

D5V

42

G2

B+

43

G1

+F

-9.7

44

VDD

21
MA-400 BOARD (8/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-26)

REMOTE CONTROL
RECEIVER

-F

VSS

IC460

-11V

-9.6

B-

9.1

B+

4-24

P17
P16
P15
P14
P13
P12
P11
P10
P9
P8
P7
P6
P5
P4
P3
P2
P1

F+
F+

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
MA-400 (POWER SUPPLY) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
Ref. No.: MA-400 board; 1,000 series

See page 4-5 for printed wiring board.

10

11

12

IC601
PQ12RD08

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)

13V

B+

B+
R624
10k

Q613
PDTC144EK-115
SWITCH

4.9

Q612
2SB1122-ST-TD
SWITCH

11.9

B+

B+

3.2

B+

JL625

5.9

5.1

PS602
0.25A

5.9

Q607
2SB1122-ST-TD

Q607,608
C+5V SWITCH

B+

SW5V

(SEE PAGE 4-17)

18
MA-400 BOARD (5/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-19)

ANGND

C611
47u
25V

C612
0.01u

C613
100u
16V

R617
1k

B+
C+12V

SW5V

MA-400 BOARD (1/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-10)

ANGND

C621
220u
6.3V

4.9
0.1

MA-400 BOARD (4/8)

C+12V

B+

R615
820

C+12V

B+

11.9
R611
1k

15

B+

R626
1k

C618
22u
50V

R625
4700

R618
1800

JL624

11.2

13.3

11.9

CONT

C+12V REG

GND

IC601

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE

12V

C+5V

B+

B+

Q608
PDTC144EK-115
JL627

B+

D603
MPG06D-6052PKG3

JS603

SE610:A,G,K,N

B+

SE610:B,E/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

B+

JS604

B+

SW5V

20

ANGND

MA-400 BOARD (6/8)

D6V

(SEE PAGE 4-21)

SW30V

B+
B+

B+

B+
JL421

B+
AN GND

OSDVCC

CAPSTAN VCC

CAPSTAN VCC

MTR 12V

MTR 12V

MTR GND

MTR GND

B+
JL600
JL628

JL602

P CONT M24V

(SEE PAGE 4-34)

P CONT M18V

10

P CONT M12V

11

13V

12

SW12V

13

D6V

14

SW5V

15

SW5V

16

AN GND

17

AN GND

18

AN GND

19

B+

JL603

B+

B+

D607

MPG06D-6052PKG3

B+

D606

MPG06D-6052PKG3

B+

SRV938EK BOARD
CN202
(SEE PAGE 4-34)

-11V

+F

D GND

-F

D GND

MTR12V
MTRGND

13

D5V_BACKUP
D5V

MA-400 BOARD (3/8)


(SEE PAGE 4-13)

PCONT_M18V

JL606

PCONT_M12V

JL607

-11VCONT

JL608
JL609
JL610

B+
R627
1M

B+

38V

CAPSTANVCC

PCONT_M24V

B+

JL613
1

ANGND

PCONT_SW5V

JL604

7P
-11V CONT

SW5V

DGND

JL626

JL605

G
CN601

B+

SW12V

C+/SW12VCONT

SRV938EK BOARD
CN201

B+

JL601

B+

19P

B+

CN600

B+

OSDVCC

ANGND
JL614
D5V

JL615

-11V
JL616
+F
JL617

21
MA-400 BOARD (7/8)
(SEE PAGE 4-23)

DGND
JL618
-F
JL619

B-

B05

Note: The components identified by mark 0 or dotted line


with mark 0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

POWER SUPPLY
4-25

4-26

MA-400 (8/8)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
DS-95 (MODE CONTROL), JK-201 (FRONT IN) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
Ref. No.:DS-95 board, JK-201 board; 1,000 series

DS-95 BOARD
A

NO MARK:REC/PB MODE
SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717
5P

CN453

D GND
MA-400 BOARD (7/8)
CN461
(SEE PAGE 4-23)

A/D1 GO

A/D1 RTN

A/D2 RTN

A/D2 GO

SE810/SX810/X9
CN450
5P

DMS-2

COM

STOP

PLAY

PLAY

S450

STOP
DUAL MODE
SHUTTLE

S451

11P

JL451
1

A/D1 GO

A/D1 RTN

A/D2 RTN

A/D2 GO

MA-400 BOARD (7/8)


CN460

DMS+ 6

(SEE PAGE 4-23)

DMS-

D5V

JOG LED CONT

KKP+

10

KKP-

11

R457
1k

JL452
JL453

R451
2200

R458
1500
JL460

JL461

JL462

JL454
JL455
JL456
JS450

JL457
JL458

B+

D GND

DMS-1

2
5

S457
CN451

JL459

SE610/SE710/
SX710/SX717

JL440
JL441
R452
1k

D
R450
180

JL442

R453
1500
S453

S452

R455
JL444 3300

R454
JL443 2200
S454

D450
SLR-342DCT31

S455

JL445

R456
4700
S456

S410

JOG

JOG

4.7

DIAL TIMER
SE810/SX810/X9

SE610/SE710/
SX710/SX717

PUSH/TURN
SE810/SX810/X9

Q450
PDTC144EK-115
LED DRIVE

SE810/SX810/X9
05

JK-201 BOARD

SE810/SX810/X9
R490
470

CN480

C491
0.001u

5P

R491
470

JL490

FRONT VIDEO IN

MA-400 BOARD
(5/8)
CN501

AN GND

FRONT AU(L) IN

(SEE PAGE 4-19)

AU GND

FRONT AU(R) IN

JL491
JL492

J481
3P

C493
0.001u

JL493

R
JL494

AUDIO

C481
0.001u
L

D481
STZ6.8N-T146
D490
STZ6.8N-T146

SIGNAL PATH
VIDEO SIGNAL

Y/CHROMA

D491
STZ6.8N-T146

D480
PDZ6.8B-115

VIDEO

R480
75

AUDIO
SIGNAL

REC
05

4-27

MODE CONTROL, FRONT IN


DS-95, JK-201

4-28

LINE-2
IN

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

DS-95 (MODE CONTROL) PRINTED WIRING BOARD


Ref. No.: DS-95 board; 1,000 series
There are a few cases that the part isn't mounted in this model is printed on this diagram.

JK-201 (FRONT IN) PRINTED WIRING BOARD


Ref. No.: JK-201 board; 1,000 series

MA-400
VIDEO, AUDIO, I/O,
SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL,
TUNER, MODE CONTROL

)
POWER BLOCK
(SRV938EK)
(POWER SUPPLY)

JK-201
(SE810/SX810/X9)
(FRONT IN)
DS-95
(MODE CONTROL)

4-30

MODE CONTROL, FRONT IN


4-29

DS-95, JK-201

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SRV938EK (POWER SUPPLY) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
Ref. No.: SRV938EK board; 2,000 series
There are a few cases that the part isn't mounted in this model is printed on this diagram.

SRV938EK BOARD

C209

PS251

D303

Q304

C303

R311

D302

Q301
Q303

R307

R219

R312

R313

Q305

R208
R222

Q206

C212

Q205

VR251
IC251

05

D203
R209
R207

PS202
PS201

PC151

D204

R218

Q204

C213

D205
C207

Q207

C104

D254

R302

L205

L202

R217
Q307

R314

R203

C202

C252
C301

R252

C206

C208
C201

R316

D253
C103

R315

Q201

L201

C253

IC151

D304

L151
Q151
D152

D252

C155
R160

R159

C156

R157

R152

L102

D301

D154

R156

D153

R151

C102
D104

C251
C203

R101

Z101

C101

D158
R158

D307

C254

A-3
A-5
B-6
B-5
B-6
B-6
B-6
B-6
B-6
A-5
A-6
A-6
A-6
B-6
A-6
A-6

T151

R164

Q151
Q201
Q203
Q204
Q205
Q206
Q207
Q210
Q211
Q301
Q302
Q303
Q304
Q305
Q306
Q307

D251

D151
C151

C109

B-3
B-4

L103

C108

IC151
IC251

R251

D103

B-1
B-1
B-1
B-1
A-3
A-3
A-3
B-3
A-3
B-6
A-6
A-6
A-4
A-4
B-4
B-4
A-4
A-6
A-6
A-4
A-6

L101

D102
D101

D101
D102
D103
D104
D151
D152
D153
D154
D158
D203
D204
D205
D251
D252
D253
D254
D301
D302
D303
D304
D307

SRV938EK BOARD

C105

A-1
A-5
A-6

CN101
CN201
CN202

1-468-458-

MA-400
VIDEO, AUDIO, I/O,
SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL,
TUNER, MODE CONTROL

)
POWER BLOCK
(SRV938EK)
(POWER SUPPLY)

JK-201
(SE810/SX810/X9)
(FRONT IN)
DS-95
(MODE CONTROL)

POWER SUPPLY
SRV938EK

4-31

4-32

11

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SRV938EK (POWER SUPPLY) SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
Ref. No.: SRV938EK board; 2,000 series

10

11

SRV938EK BOARD
A

0
T151
POWER TRANSFORMER

D101-104
IN4005

D103

D101

D104

D102

R151
1M
+ C151
47
400V

D151
P6KE300ARL
Q151
SWITCHING
REG

R152
1M

2.6 1

C158
820p

1.6 2

IC151
TDA16846

Q151
2SK3047

D252
UF3DL

36.4

B+

12

11

R161
33k

10

5.9 7

D302
0.5 D2S4M

R308
1k D303

36.4

Q306
DTC143EKA

L201
10H

C252
680
25V

C201
220
25V

Q201
2SB733

B+

C253
1200
10V

VR251
+6V
5k

R266
3.3k

4.6

C261
0.22

IC251 2.5
AN1431T
R164
18k

750mA

IC251

2.4

SHUNT
REG

4.6

R263
18k

C206 R206
47
1.5k
35V
+

R219
4.7k

0.7

R220
4.7k

Q203
SWITCH
Q203
2PD601A

5.9

B+

0 PS202 2A

C202 +
470
10V

+ C203
220
16V

0 PS201 1.6A

R207
220
D203
MTZJ5.1
D204
1SS119

L205
1H

0 PS251

B
PC151
ON3171 5.6

R264
15k

C254
470
25V

D254 R252
PR1003 0.22

IC151

R265
10k

B+
B+

R203
180
2W

L202
10H
R261
1k

0.8

B+

5.9

POWER
CONTROL

R201
1k

Q201, 204
SWITCH

D154
PR1003
D253
SB340L

B+

13.5

Q204
2SC2785

C156
1
50v

Q303-306
SWITCH
D304
D2S4M

+ C303
22
50V

R311
10k

R307 1k 1W MTZJ20

36.4

B+

13.4

Q304
2SB733 0 2SC2785 0

12.8

2.2

C161
1000p

0 Q305

13.6

R160
33

CN201 19P

Q303 2SD2394

36.4

14

13

B+

R306
10k

2.9

C209
0.01

R314
1k
2W

R302 1k 1W

B+
R312 R313
10
10
2W
2W

13.2

2.4

D30
D2S4M
R315
1k
2W

Q302
DTC143EKA

315

C155
22
50V

R163 3.9k

C160
10000p

R301
10k 36.3

R316
100k

R159
22

C157
1000p

5.6

C301
220
50V

R158
82

Q301
2SD2394
Q307 0.3
2SA1015

B+

R162
33k

C159 100p

B+

C109
2200p
250V

B+
36.4

C251 +
47
50V

R157
2.2M

Q301, 302 307


SWITCH

R251
56

36.4

D152
UF4007

R155 D158
10k MA4270 2.8

D153
1SS119

R156
2.2M

C108
2200p
250V

D301
UF3DL

B+

L151

C153
3300p

D251
PR1003

R222 220
R209
220

CAPSTAN VCC

CAPSTAN VCC

MTR 12V

MTR 12V

MTR GND

MTR GND

P CONT M24V

10

P CONT M18V

11

P CONT M12V

12

13V

13

SW 12V

14

D6V

15

SW 5V

16

SW 5V

17

AN GND

18

AN GND

19

AN GND

11V CONT

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)


CN600
(SEE PAGE 4-25)

5.9

B+

C207
+ 10
50V

Q206
SWITCH

+ C213
0.1
50V

C212
0.01

R210
1k

R218
33
3W

11.7

11.7

R213
47k

Q207
2SD1862
11.1

R216
4.7k

CN202 7P

38V

11V

+F (2.9V)

D GND

F (0V)

D GND

MA-400 BOARD (8/8)


CN601
(SEE PAGE 4-25)

R217
10
5.9 1W

5.9

OSD VCC

5.2

C208
470
10V

10.2

AN GND

5.2

Q205
2SD2394
SW5V REG

R208
220

Q206
2SC2785
D205
6.5
1SS119

Q210
DTA114EKA
0

Q211
DTC114EKA

0
CN101
2P
2

0
Z101

AC IN

0
R101
1M
1/2W

L101
10H

C101
0.1
275V

0 0

C104
1000p C102
250V 0.1
275V
C103
1000p
250V

L102
33mH

Q207, 210, 211


SWITCH

0
L103
33mH

F101
T2AL
250V

C105
1000p
250V

05

Note: The components identified by mark 0 or dotted line


with mark 0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

POWER SUPPLY
4-33

4-34 E

SRV938EK

MA-400
IC162wf

MA-400
IC162ql

MA-400
IC162yf

RF SWP

QVD

C V IN

*3

*1

STOP/
FF/
REW

TAPE

*3

*1

LOADING

TAPE

*3

*1

UNLOADING

*3

*2

*1

PB

*3

*1

REC

REC

*3

*1

PAUSE

1.
2.
3.
4.

5-1

MA-400
IC162<z/v>

MA-400
IC162ej

MA-400
IC162i;

MA-400
IC162ul

CAP FG

CAP RVS

CAP ERR

DRUM ERR

25 Hz pulse.
Pulse of period in proportion to tape speed.
25 Hz H pulse.
330 Hz pulse.

I/O

I/O

MA-400
IC162<z/n>

MA-400
IC162<z/m>

IC162<zzx>

MA-400

Pin No.

DRUM FG

DRUM PG

CTL IN+

Signal

*6

H/L

H/L

*4

*3

*7

STOP

5.
6.
7.

*6

*6

*2

*4

*3

*7

REW

*6

*6

*5

*4

*3

*7

TAPE
LOADING

Unstable period pulse.


DC voltage 1 to 5V
Hi-Z (2.5V)

*6

*6

*2

*4

*3

*7

FF

*6

*6

*5

*4

*3

*7

TAPE
UNLOADING

*6

*6

*2

*4

*3

*7

PB

*6

*6

*2

*4

*3

*1

REC

5-2. SYSTEM CONTROL SERVO PERIPHERAL CIRCUIT INTERFACE (MA-400 BOARD IC162)

1. 25 Hz pulse with 50% duty cycle. Synchronized with rotation of drum.


2. Normally L. H when video signal is not generated.
3. Composite sync signal (positive polarity).

I/O

Pin No.

Signal

5-1. SYSTEM CONTROL VIDEO BLOCK INTERFACE (MA-400 BOARD IC162)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 5
INTERFACE, IC PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION

5-2

1.
2.
3.
4.

MA-400
IC162ra

MA-400
IC162r;

MA-400
IC162el

MA-400
IC162rd

MA-400
IC162od

MA-400
IC162of

MA-400
IC162wh

MA-400
IC1620

MODE 2

MODE 3

MODE 4

REC PRF

T REEL

S REEL

END LED

T SENS

*3

*3

H/L

H/L

EJECTED

*3

*3

H/L

H/L

*1

H/M

*3

*3

H/L

H/L

*1

L/M

*4

*4

*3

*2

H/L

*1

H/M

*4

*4

*3

*2

H/L

*1

L/M

*4

*4

*3

H/L

H/L

*1

TAPE
TAPE
CASSETTE CASSETTE
THREAD- UNTHREAD- STOP
LOADING UNLOADING
ING
ING

L when erasing protection tab is bent. H when not bent.


Pulse of period in proportion to reel rotating speed.
Approx. 2 msec period H pulse.
Normally L. 2 msec period H pulse when tape top or tape end is detected.

MA-400
IC162rs

MODE 1

MA-400
IC1629

MA-400
IC162rh

CAM

S SENS

I/O

Pin No.

Signal

*4

*4

*3

*2

*2

*1

FF

*4

*4

*3

*2

*2

*1

REW

*4

*4

*3

*2

*2

*1

PB

*4

*4

*3

*2

*2

*1

REC

5-3. SYSTEM CONTROL MECHANISM BLOCK INTERFACE (MA-400 BOARD IC162)

5-3

MA-400
IC162ts

MA-400
IC162ok

MA-400
IC162oj

RESET

NICAM DATA

NICAM CLK

Serial communication clock to with Tuner.

Serial communication data to Tuner.

Normally H, L when service interruption is detected or restored.

I/O Level

I/O

Pin No.

MA-400
IC162uf

Signal

A MUTE

STOP/
FF/
REW

L
L

TAPE
TAPE
LOADING UNLOADING
L

PB
L

REC
H

PB
PAUSE

5-5. SYSTEM CONTROL AUDIO BLOCK INTERFACE (MA-400 BOARD IC162)

I/O

Pin No.

Signal

5-4. SYSTEM CONTROL SYSTEM CONTROL PERIPHERAL CIRCUIT INTERFACE (MA-400 BOARD IC162)

5-4

I
O

VSS
17.734475MHz (in)
17.734475MHz (out)

VCC

32kHz (in)
32kHz (out)
TEST
CAP RVS

33

34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49

EURO 21 pin AV CONT signal output

HiFi record control signal


Full erase control signal for A DUB

O
O

IIC CLK1 (EEP)


IIC DATA1 (EEP)

CAM

NC
NC
NC

I
O
O

I
O

I
O

IIC data (EEPROM control)


Cam motor control signal
Not used (open)
Not used (open)
Connected to Ground

Inverted capstan signal


EURO 21 pin-I CONT signal output
Cam encode data 4
Cam encode data 3
Cam encode data 2
Cam encode data 1
Safety tab detection input
IIC clock (EEPROM control)

test terminal

Sub clock output

Sub clock input

Ground terminal
Main clock input
Main clock output
Power supply input terminal
(high speed mode: 4.0 to 5.5V, low speed mode: 2.6 to 5.5V)

HiFi switching pulse output


End sensor LED output

O
O

I
O

I
I
I
I
I
O
I/O

I CONT
MODE 4
MODE 3
MODE 2
MODE 1
REC PRF

ENV S
RF SWP
AF SWP
END LED
AV CONT
AF REC P
FULL ERS

Head azimuth information

SP/EP head switching signal


Identification signal of SP/EP head output comparison & detection
Video RF switching pulse output

NC
CROT
HA SW

I
O

KKP -

QVD

KKP +

MOD CONT

KKP 2-phase pulse A input


Quasi VD pulse
Not used (open)

Not used (open)


RF modulator ON/OFF control
KKP 2-phase pulse B input

I
I
I
I

I
I

Tape end sensor input


Tape top sensor input
Video RF envelope input
HiFi envelope input
Function key input (9 keys)
Function key input (9 keys)

AF ENV
FU KEY2
FU KEY1
POWER KEY

AFT input from TUNER for station selection

I
I

DEST1
DEST2
TU AFT
S SENS
T SENS
RF ENV

Function

Not used (open)


Not used (open)
Not used (open)
Not used (open)
24 V power control signal
Destination identification input 1
Destination identification input 2

NC
NC
NC
NC
24V CONT

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32

I/O

Pin Name

Pin No.

NC

T REEL
S REEL

TU SW2

FLD CS
SW5V CONT

SECAM ON

18V CONT
TO FLD DATA

NC
FLD CLOCK

I
I

O
O

O
O

O
O

I
O

I
O
O

P FAIL
DRUM ERR
CAP ERR
SAT CONT
-11V CONT
TO AV LINK
C+5V CONT

REMOCON

I
I

O
O
O

FROM AV LINK

A MUTE
MTR12V CONT

TA MUTE

DIV CLK OUT/JOGLED CONT

72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95

I
I

PDC DAV
AV CONT IN/C+DET

DMS TU SW1

I
I
O

NC
DEC/VTR

DMS +

C V IN (C SYNC IN)

I/O

65
66
67
68
69
70
71

64

OSD SECAM C IN

HLF (SLICER LPF)

62
63

MD0
OSD V OUT

CLK SEL

59
60
61

OSD V IN
OSD GND
OSD W LEVEL

I
I/O

RESET
OSD LPF
LP
OSD VCC
O

I/O
I/O
I/O

Pin Name
OSC CHARA (IN)
OSC CHARA (OUT)

50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58

Pin No.

5-6. SERVO/SYSTEM CONTROL MICROPROCESSOR PIN FUNCTION (MA-400 BOARD IC162)

SECAM ON signal/surround audio control (switched by destination)


Chip selection signal for display tube driver
SW 5 V power control signal
Tuner system BGL/L selection signal
Take up reel sensor input
Supply reel sensor input
Not used (open)

Serial clock CH0 (FLD)


18 V power control signal
Serial data out CH0 (FLD)

Not used (open)

SAT control signal


Power save control
AV-LINK data output for communication
Power save control

Power failure detection input


Drum error output
Capstan error output

AV-LINK data input for communication


Remote control SIRCS signal input

Tuner audio mute signal output


Audio mute signal output
Motor 12 V power control signal

PDC/VPS signal reception identification input


CANAL + connection identification input
Terminal of using JOG LED output or adjustment
made output of clock dividing frequency

Tuner system BG/L selection signal


Not used (open)
Decoder/VTR switching Not used (open)

DMS 2-phase pulse 1 input


DMS 2-phase pulse 2 input

Color signal input for SECAM OSD


Video signal input for tuners station selection,
OSD and servo sync signal detection (after passing filter)

OSD video signal output


LPF connection terminal for slicer/AFC
(This terminal is used as the HLF terminal when C. Video is input to pin-56.)

Connected to Ground

Video signal input for OSD overlay


Ground terminal of OSD/slicer
OSD white level input
Selection of oscillation clock when reset is canceled
L: sub clock, H: main & sub clocks

Reset input
External filter that doubles the FSC, is connected to this terminal
L at SP, H at EP/LP
Power supply input terminal for OSD/slicer (4.75 V to 5.25 V)

Function
Clock input for OSD character size
Clock output for OSD character size

5-5
5-5E

101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116

100

AVCC

AMP VCC

CTL AMP OUT

AMPC

NC
CTL INCTL IN+

AMP VREF IN

CAP FG
AMP VSS
DRUM FG
DRUM PG
AMP VREF OUT

NC
NC
SECAM DET

MOD/VPS)

SDA (VI/HF/TU/ARC/

MOD/VPS)

NC
NICAM CLK
NICAM DATA
SCL (VI/HF/TU/ARC/

96
97
98

99

Pin Name

Pin No.

I/O

Power supply input terminal for analog amplifier (connected to Vcc)


Power supply input and reference voltage input to A-D converter

CTL signal input/output terminal


CTL amplifier AC Ground terminal
CTL amplifier output

CTL signal input/output terminal

Analog amplifier reference power supply output terminal


Analog amplifier reference power supply output terminal
Connected to Ground

Drum FG input
Drum PG input

Ground terminal for analog amplifier (connected to Vss)

SECAM identification input


Capstan FG input

I
I

IIC data (video/HiFi/tuner/ARC/modulator/VPS control)

Not used (open)


Not used (open)

I
I

I/O

Function

IIC clock (video/HiFi/tuner/ARC/modulator/VPS control)

Clock for NICAM-ZWEI control


Data for NICAM-ZWEI control

Not used (open)

I/O

I/O

O
O

I/O

S16
VEE

29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44

S12
S13
S14
S15

25
26
27
28

VSS

G5
G4
G3
G2
G1
VDD

G9
G8
G7
G6

S17
S18
G10

S6
S7
S8
S9
S10
S11

S5

S4

S1
S2
S3

VSS
VDD

CS
KEY1
KEY2

CLK

OSC
D OUT
D IN

LED1
LED2
LED3
LED4

Pin Name

18
19
20
21
22
23
24

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17

Pin No.

O
O
O
O
O

Grid terminal 5
Grid terminal 4
Grid terminal 3
Grid terminal 2
Grid terminal 1
Power supply (D5V)
Ground

Grid terminal 9 Not used (open)


Grid terminal 8 Not used (open)
Grid terminal 7 Not used (open)
Grid terminal 6

Power supply (11V)


Segment terminal 17
Segment terminal 18 Not used (open)
Grid terminal 10 Not used (open)
O
O
O
O

Segment terminal 16

Function

O
O
O

Segment terminal 12
Segment terminal 13
Segment terminal 14
Segment terminal 15

Segment terminal 6
Segment terminal 7
Segment terminal 8
Segment terminal 9
Segment terminal 10
Segment terminal 11

Segment terminal 4
Segment terminal 5

Segment terminal 1
Segment terminal 2
Segment terminal 3

Ground
Ground
Ground
Power supply (D5V)

FLD clock
FLD chip select input

FLD IIC BUS (data) input

Not used (open)

Not used (open)


Not used (open)
Not used (open)
Terminal for osciration

Not used (open)

O
O
O
O

O
O
O
O
O
O

I
I

O
O
O

I
I

O
O
O

I/O

5-7. MODE CONTROL PIN FUNCTION (MA-400 BOARD IC420)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 6
ERROR CODES
6-1. ERROR CODE INDICATION

Error codes are indicated using the lower 5 digits in the fluorescent display tube.
At this time, Colon :between character is not indicated.

Mode code indication when the error has occurred.


Error code

ERROR CODE
0

No error

Cam encoder error Loading direction

Cam encoder error Unloading direction

T reel error

S reel error

Capstan error

Drum error

Error on initializing

Cassette loading error

Reserve

MODE CODE
0

Power-on eject

10

FWD x1

20

REW play

Power-on initial

Power-off elect

11

FWD x2

21

Cas. loading

12

CUE

22

Tape loading

3
4

Power-off stop

13

PB-pause

23

Power-off loading

FF

14

RVS-pause

24

Mecha. error (Power on)

REW

15

RVS x1

25

Power-on eject initial

REC

16

RVS x2

26

Power-off eject initial

REC-pause

17

REV

27

APC REC

Power-on stop

18

Power-off initial

28

PB

19

Mecha. error (Power off)

6-1
6-1E

Cas. loading
(No auto PB check)

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 7
ADJUSTMENTS
2-1-3. Set-up of Adjustment
In this adjustment, PAL or NTSC pattern generator is connected
with LINE input signal terminal. When checking with tuner, connected AERIAL terminal. Check that the amplitudes of video signal SYNC signal, of picture portions, and of burst signals are flat
at approximately 0.3, 0.7 and 0.3 V, respectively, and that the level
ratio of the burst signal and red signal are 0.30: 0.66. Fig. 7-2-2.
shows video signals (color bars) used in adjusting the video section.

During the adjustment, see the Parts Arrangement


Diagram for Adjustments on Page 7-6.

7-1. MECHANICAL ADJUSTMENTS


Refer to the SERVICE MANUAL of VHS MECHANICAL ADJUSTMENT VI.

7-2. ELECTRICAL ADJUSTMENTS


PAL

2-1.

PRE-ADJUSTMENT PREPARATIONS

Necessary items and indications for total adjustment of electric


circuit of this machine will be described in this chapter.
2-1-1. Instruments to be Used
1) Color TV
2) Oscilloscope 1 or 2 phenomena, band more than 30 MHz, delay mode, as provided.
3) NTSC pattern generator
4) PAL pattern generator
5) Digital voltmeter
6) Audio level meter
7) Audio noise meter
8) Audio generator
9) Attenuator
10) Alignment tape
Part Code: 8-192-605-36 KRV-51P (PAL)
Part Code: 8-192-605-32 KRV-51N2 (NTSC)

NTSC

2-1-2. Connection
Unless otherwise specified, connect and adjust the measuring instruments as shown in the following diagram.
VIDEO LINE IN

Fig. 7-2-2
Pattern generator

VCR

Monitor TV

2-1-4. Alignment Tapes


[Alignment Tape (KRV-51N2/KRV-51P)]

1
Video output
(75 )

VIDEO LINE OUT

Fig. 7-2-1

Mode

Time

Video signal

SP

Seven minutes

Color bar

SP

Three minutes

Monoscope

EP

Seven minutes

Color bar

EP

Three minutes

Monoscope

Audio signal
(HiFi/Normal)

400 Hz

2-1-5. Specified I/O Level and Impedance


Input/output terminal
Video inputs
LINE IN : phono jack
1 Vp-p, 75 , unbalanced, sync negative
Audio inputs
LINE IN : phono jacks
47 kW, 7.5 dBs (0 dBs = 0.775 Vrms)
More than 10 kW, 4 dBs
Video outputs
LINE OUT: phono jack
1 Vp-p, 75 , unbalanced, sync negative
Audio outputs
LINE OUT: phono jacks
7.5 dBs at load impedance 47 k
Output impedance : less than 10

7-1

2-1-6. Adjusting Sequence


Make the electrical adjustment in the following sequence.

2-3.

SERVO SYSTEM ADJUSTMENT

2-3-1.

RF Switching Position Adjustment


(MA-400 BOARD)
Purpose:
Adjust the interval between A ch and B ch of tape playback output.
Improve the interchangeability with other tapes and sets.
When it is out of order, the interval appears on the screen, the
screen is disturbed.

Power supply adjustment

Servo system adjustment

Audio system adjustment

2-2.
2-2-1.

POWER SUPPLY ADJUSTMENTS


Power Supply Check
(SRV938EK BOARD)

Mode

E-E

Measuring Instrument

Digital voltmeter

Mode

PB

Signal

Alignment tape SP mode


color
bar

Measurement Point

CH1: VIDEO LINE OUT


CH2: Pin 2 of CN262
(RF SWP)

Measuring Instrument

Oscilloscope

Specified Value

6.5 0.5 H (416 32 sec)


PAL
6.5 0.5 H (410 32 sec)
NTSC

MTR12 V check
Measurement Point

Pin 5, 6 of CN201

Specified Value

13.5 0.4 V

Adjusting Method:
1) During playback, connect MA-400 board CN262 pin 3 and
the pin 5 for about 1 second to activate the RF switching
position adjustment mode.
2) Check appear A P on FL display.
3) Using the channel + and buttons, adjust to 6.5 0.5 H.
4) Press the pause button.

D6 V check
Measurement Point

Pin qf of CN201

Specified Value

5.9 0.2 V

+13 V check
Measurement Point

Pin qs of CN201

Specified Value

13.6 0.5 V

+38 V check
Measurement Point

Pin 2 of CN202

Specified Value

35.0 3.5 V

CH1
CH2

SW 5 Vcheck

Approx. 5 Vp-p

Measurement Point

Pin qg, qh of CN201

Specified Value

5.2 0.2 V

V
enlargement

+F, F check
Measurement Point

Pin 4, 6 of CN202

Specified Value

2.9

+ 0.6
0.3

Vertical sync. signal

11 V check

CH1

Measurement Point

Pin 3 of CN202

Specified Value

11.5 1.0 V
CH2

Checking Method:
1) Confirm that each voltage meets its specified value.
2-2-2.

Approx. 1 Vp-p

Fig. 7-2-3.

+6 V Adjustment
(SRV938EK BOARD)

Mode

REC or PB

Measuring Instrument

Digital voltmeter

Measurement Point

Pin qf of CN201

Adjusting Element

VR251

Specified Value

5.9 0.2 V

6.5 0.5 H
(416 32 sec) PAL
(410 32 sec) NTSC

7-2

2-4.

AUDIO SYSTEM ADJUSTMENTS

CH1
RF SWP

Adjust both Lch and Rch.


[Connection]
Audio
generator

Audio level meter or


distortion meter
600

47 k

OK

Attenuator
VCR

CH2
NG

AUDIO LINE IN
Feed signal both
channelssimultaneously.

AUDIO LINE OUT

Fig. 7-2-5.

Fig. 7-2-4.

2. Frequency Response Check


Purpose:
Confirm that the frequency characteristic is within the specification.

2-4-1. Hi-Fi Audio System Adjustment


Set switches and knobs to the following positions to make adjustment unless otherwise specified.
INPUT SELECT switch ................... LINE
AUDIO MONITOR .......................... STEREO
[Adjustment Sequence]
1. AF Switching Position Adjustment
2. Frequency Response Check
3. Overall Level Characteristic and Distortion Factor
Check
4. Overall S/N Check
AF Switching Position Adjustment
(MA-400 BOARD)
Purpose:
Adjust the interval between A CH and B CH of tape playback
output. Improve the interchangeability with other tapes and sets.
When it is out of order, noisy sound is increased and big noise is
heard.

Mode

REC and PB (SP, LP mode)

Signal

400 Hz, 26.3 dBs


30 Hz, 26.3 dBs
20 kHz, 26.3 dBs

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio level meter

Specified value

0 3 dB

1.

Mode

PB

Signal

Alignment tape SP mode


color bar

Measurement point

CH1: Pin 2 of CN262


CH2: Pin 1 of CN262

Measuring Instrument

Oscilloscope

Specified Value

Fig. 7-2-5

Note: Tape path adjustment must have been completed.


Confirmation Method:
1) Supply a signal of 400 Hz, 26.3 dBs to both L and R channels of Audio Line Input.
2) Connect the audio level meter to the Audio Line Output.
3) Adjust the attenuator so that the audio level meter will indicate 26.3 dBs.
4) Make recording.
5) Set an audio line input signal to 30 Hz and make recording.
6) Set an audio line input signal to 20 kHz and make recording.
7) Playback a recorded portion, and measure output levels at 400
Hz and 30 Hz and 20 kHz.
8) Confirm that the 30 Hz and 20 kHz playback output level within
a range of the 400 Hz playback output level 0 3 dB.

Adjusting Method:
1) During playback, connect MA-400 board CN262 pin 3 and
the pin 5 for about 1 second to activate the RF switching
position adjustment mode.
2) Press the record button to activate the AF switching position
adjustment mode.
3) Check appear A H on FL display.
4) Using the channels + and buttons, minimize a chipped portion. At this time, confirm that a noisy sound is not heard.
5) Press the pause button.

7-3

3. Overall Level Characteristic and Distortion Factor


Check
Purpose:
Check the record level, play level, and distortion factor against the
reference input.
Mode

2-4-2. Normal Audio System Adjustment


Make adjustment in the SP mode, unless otherwise specified.
Use a normal VHS cassette for an adjustment tape.
Set AUDIO MONITOR to normal.
[Adjustment Sequence]
1. ACE Head Adjustment
2. E-E Output Level Check
3. Frequency Response Check
4. Overall Level Characteristic and Distortion Factor
Check
5. Overall S/N Check

REC and PB (SP mode)

Signal

400 Hz, 6.3 dBs

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio level meter and


distortion factor meter

Specified value

Playback level: 6.3 2.0 dBs


Distortion factor: 1% or less

1. ACE Head Adjustment


Refer to the SERVICE MANUAL of VHS MECHANICAL ADJUSTMENT VI.

Confirmation Method:
1) Supply an audio signal of 400 Hz, 6.3 dBs simultaneously to
both L and R channels of Audio Line Input.
2) Make recording
3) Play back a recorded portion.
4) Confirm that a playback level is 6.3 2.0 dBs.
5) Confirm that a distortion factor is within 1%.

2. E-E Output Level Check


Purpose:
Confirm that the output level against the reference input is within
the specification.

4. Overall S/N Check


Purpose:
Confirm that the S/N is within the specification.
Mode

REC and PB (SP mode)

Signal

Short

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio noise meter

Specified value

67.5 dBs or less

Mode

E-E

Signal

L, R: 400 Hz, 6.3 dBs

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio level meter

Specified value

6.3 2.0 dBs

Confirmation Method:
1) Simultaneously input a signal of 400 Hz, 6.3 dBs to both L
and R channels of Audio Line Input.
2) Confirm that the audio output level is 6.3 2.0 dBs.
(This level only can appear with mono models)

Confirmation Method:
1) Connect both L and R channels of audio line input to the GND.
2) Start recording.
3) Play the recorded part to confirm that the noise is below 67.5
dBs.

3. Frequency Response Check


Purpose:
Confirm that the frequency characteristic is within the specification.
Mode

REC and PB (SP mode)

Signal

400 Hz, 26.3 dBs


7 kHz, 26.3 dBs

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio level meter

Specified value

0 3 dB

Tape path adjustment must have been completed.


Confirmation Method:
1) Supply a signal of 400 Hz, 26.3 dBs to both L and R channels of Audio Line Input.
2) Connect the audio level meter to the Audio Line Output.
3) Adjust the attenuator so that the audio level meter will indicate 26.3 dBs.
4) Make recording in the SP mode.
5) Set an audio line input signal to 7 kHz and make recording.
6) Playback a recorded portion, and measure output levels at 400
Hz and 7 kHz.
7) Confirm that the 7 kHz playback output level within a range
of the 400 Hz playback output level 0 3 dB.

7-4

4. Overall Level Characteristic and Distortion Factor


Check
Purpose:
Check the record level, play level, and distortion factor against the
reference input.

2-5.

PARTS ARRANGEMENT DIAGRAM FOR ADJUSTMENTS

MA-400 BOARD (Side A)


6

Mode
Signal

400 Hz, 6.3 dBs

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio level meter and


distortion factor meter

Specified value

Playback level: 6.3 3.0 dBs


Distortion factor: 4% or less

Confirmation Method:
1) Supply an audio signal of 400 Hz, 6.3 dBs simultaneously to
both L and R channels of Audio Line Input.
2) Make recording
3) Play back a recorded portion.
4) Confirm that a playback level is 6.3 3.0 dBs.
5) Confirm that a distortion factor is within 4%.
5. Overall S/N Check
Purpose:
Confirm that the S/N is within the specification.
Mode

REC and PB (SP mode)

Signal

Short

Measurement point

Audio output terminal

Measurement equipment

Audio noise meter

Specified value

45.5 dBs or less

1
CN262

REC and PB (SP mode)

Confirmation Method:
1) Connect both L and R channels of audio line input to the GND.
2) Start recording.
3) Play the recorded part to confirm that the noise is below 45.5
dBs.

SRV938EK BOARD (Side A)

7
6

1
2
CN202

19
18

1
2
CN201

VR251
+6 V

7-5

7-6 E

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9
SECTION 8
REPAIR PARTS LIST
8-1.

Ref. No.

EXPLODED VIEWS

NOTE:
-XX and -X mean standardized parts, so they may
have some difference from the original one.
Color Indication of Appearance Parts
Example:
KNOB, BALANCE (WHITE) . . . (RED)

Parts Color
Cabinet's Color

Items marked * are not stocked since they are


seldom required for routine service. Some delay
should be anticipated when ordering these items.
The mechanical parts with no reference number in
the exploded views are not supplied.
Hardware (# mark) list and accessories and packing materials are given in the last of the electrical
parts list.

The components identified by mark


0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

8-1-1. FRONT PANEL AND CABINET ASSEMBLIES

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

1
1
1
1
1

X-3951-270-1
X-3951-271-1
X-3951-272-1
X-3951-273-1
X-3951-274-1

PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE610: A, E, G, K, N)


PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE610B)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE710: D, E, K, N)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE710B)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE710: G, I)

10

1
1
1
1
1

X-3951-275-1
X-3951-276-1
X-3951-277-1
X-3951-278-1
X-3951-279-1

PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SX710: D, E, K, N)


PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SX710B)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SX717)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE810: D, E, K, N)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE810B)

10

1
1
1
1
1

X-3951-280-1
X-3951-281-1
X-3951-757-1
X-3951-759-1
X-3951-760-1

PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SE810G)


PANEL ASSY, FRONT (SX810)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (X9: E, D)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (X9B)
PANEL ASSY, FRONT (X9G)

10
10

10

10

10
10
10

9
1
2
* 3

10
11

* 3
4

X-3951-761-1 PANEL ASSY, FRONT (X9N)


3-953-432-01 SPRING (GE), FL
A-6794-810-A DS-95 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
A-6794-812-A DS-95 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810/SX810/X9)
1-757-593-11 CABLE, FLAT (FDS-10)
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)

10

11

8
9
9

(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)

14

1-757-594-11
1-762-844-31
A-6794-811-A
4-921-277-41
3-057-808-31

CABLE, FLAT (FDS-9) (SE810/SX810/X9)


SWITCH, ROTARY (SE810/SX810/X9)
JK-201 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810/SX810/X9)
SCREW (B2.6X8), TAPPING, BIND
CASE, UPPER (SX710/SX717/SX810)

3-057-808-51 CASE, UPPER (SE610/SE710/SE810/X9)


3-363-099-01 SCREW (CASE 3 TP2) (SX710/SX717/SX810)
3-363-099-11 SCREW (CASE 3 TP2)
(SE610/SE710/SE810/X9)

13
7

(X9: B, D, E, G)

(SE810/SX810/X9)

14

not supplied

4
3

not supplied

15
5

not supplied

8-1

8-2

Description

Remark

1-418-010-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259)


(SX717/SX810)
1-418-010-31 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259B)
(X9N)
1-418-780-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288)
(SX710: D, E, K, N)
1-418-780-21 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288A)
(SX710B)
1-418-782-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259K)
(SE810: D, E, G, K, N)
1-418-782-21 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259L)
(SE810B)
1-476-369-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259R)
(X9: D, E, G)
1-476-370-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259S)
(X9B)
1-476-406-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288B)
(SE610: A, E, G, K, N/SE710: D, E, G, I, K, N)
1-476-406-21 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288C)
(SE610B/SE710B)

13

3-709-430-01 COVER, REMOTE CONTROL


(for RMT-V259/V288/V288A/V288B/V288C)
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717/SX810)
3-709-430-11 COVER, REMOTE CONTROL
(for RMT-V259K/V259L) (SE810)
1-476-070-11 CONTROLLER, STB/SAT (RMT-CM103)
(X9: B, D, E)
1-476-070-21 CONTROLLER, STB/SAT (RMT-CM103) (X9G)

14
14
14
15
15

3-053-436-01
3-053-436-11
4-942-568-61
3-057-801-11
3-057-801-31

11
4
5
* 6
7
8

Part No.

13

EMBLEM (NO.5), SONY (SX710/SX717/SX810)


EMBLEM (NO.5), SONY (SE610/SE710/SE810)
EMBLEM (NO.5), SONY (X9)
RING (H), CHANGE SPEED (SX810)
RING (H), CHANGE SPEED (SE810/X9)

8-1-3. MECHANISM CHASSIS ASSEMBLY (1)

8-1-2. CHASSIS ASSEMBLY


not
supplied

53

707

54

#1

#3

52

52

52

#1

708

712
711

not supplied

709

55

706
704
710

51

705

723

52
not
supplied

702

52

713

720

722

725

703
701

724

not
supplied

701

721

714
716

719

56

715

717
The components identified by mark
0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

52
57

Ref. No.

Part No.

* 51

A-6713-793-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE


(SE710D/SX710D/SX717D)
A-6713-794-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE710B/SX710B)
A-6713-795-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810B)
A-6713-796-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810D/SX810)
A-6713-797-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810G)

*
*
*
*
*

A-6713-798-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE710G)


A-6713-799-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE710E/SX710E/SX717E)
A-6713-800-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE710I)
A-6713-801-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810E)
A-6713-802-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610G)

* 51

* 51
* 51
* 51
* 51
* 51
* 51
* 51
* 51
* 51
*
*
*
*

51
51
51
51

A-6713-803-A
A-6713-804-A
A-6713-805-A
A-6713-806-A

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610A)


MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610B)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610E)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9G)

8-3

51
51
51
51
51

* 51

Part No.
A-6713-807-A
A-6713-808-A
A-6713-809-A
A-6713-810-A
A-6713-811-A

Description

Remark

MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9D)


MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9B)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9E)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810N/X9N)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810K)

* 51
* 51
52

A-6713-812-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE


(SE710N/SX710N)
A-6713-813-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE710K/SX710K)
A-6713-814-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610N)
A-6713-815-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610K)
3-970-608-21 SUMITITE (B3), +BV

53
54
0 55
* 56
57

1-757-537-11
1-792-022-11
1-782-012-11
1-468-458-14
3-057-805-01

CABLE, FLAT (FAC-9)


CABLE, FLAT (FFM-001)
CORD, POWER
POWER BLOCK (SRV938EK)
BASE, MD (R), KS

718

Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

701
702
703
704
705

3-977-509-01
3-977-507-01
3-977-508-01
1-500-471-11
3-977-495-01

WASHER, THRUST
TABLE, REEL (S)
TABLE, REEL (T)
HEAD, FE
SHAFT TG2

Remark

Ref. No.
714
715
716
717
718

3-063-773-02
3-977-441-03
3-977-445-02
3-062-763-01
X-3950-964-1

OPENER, LID (SL)


GEAR, PINCH PRESSING
GEAR, TG8 ARM DRIVING
SPRING, EXTENSION (RVS BRAKE)
ARM ASSY, RVS BRAKE (SL)

706
707
708
709
710

3-977-494-01
A-6776-359-C
3-977-535-01
3-977-536-01
3-977-443-01

HOLDER, FEH
FL COMPLETE ASSY (SL)
PLATE, LUMINOUS (END SENSOR)
PLATE, LUMINOUS (TOP SENSOR)
WASHER, STOPPER

719
720
721
722
723

3-063-756-01
X-3947-590-1
A-6775-791-A
3-974-556-11
3-979-508-01

GEAR, TG8 ARM H/R


TG8 ASSY
ACE BLOCK ASSY (EURO 3)
+ HEXA TT 2.6X9 (TAPER)
SCREW +HEXA TP SW 3X8

711
712
713

A-6759-863-B PRESS BLOCK ASSY, PINCH


3-958-455-01 SPRING (PINCH), TENSION
3-977-447-01 GEAR, ELEVATOR

724
725

3-059-958-01 SPRING, TG 8
3-051-300-03 LOCK ACE SCREW

8-4

Part No.

Description

Remark

8-1-4. MECHANISM CHASSIS ASSEMBLY (2)

767
770
768
769

761
#3

764

762

758

763

760

772
763

757

#4

766

756

765

755
754
752
753

759
751

Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

751
752
753
754
755

X-3949-363-1
3-053-882-01
X-3947-573-1
X-3951-005-1
3-063-772-01

BRAKE ASSY, MAIN (T)


SPRING, TENS (MAIN BRAKE)
ARM ASSY, PENDULUM
BRAKE ASSY, MAIN (S) (B) H/R
LEVER, REC PROOF (SL)

756
757
758
759
760

3-976-767-01
3-977-487-01
X-3950-966-1
3-063-958-01
3-977-488-01

SPRING, TENS. (REC. PROOF)


BOSS, TG1 FULCRUM
TG1 ASSY (SL)
SPRING, COMP (SL PEND)
SPRING (POWER TENSION)

761
762

A-6775-463-A SHUTTLE (S) BLOCK ASSY, ST


X-3948-050-1 ROLLER ASSY, GUIDE

Remark

Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

763
764
765
766
767

3-965-178-01
3-062-687-01
A-6750-328-E
3-977-501-01
A-6746-074-G

SPRING
BASE, DRUM, K (UPPER MOTOR)
SHUTTLE (T) BLOCK ASSY
PLATE, LUMINOUS
ROLLER BLOCK ASSY, HC

768
769
770

X-3947-255-1 ROLLER ASSY, HC


3-975-724-07 ARM, HC
1-772-364-11 DRUM ASSY, DZH-0B5A-R
(EXCEPT SE610B/SE710B/
SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-772-365-11 DRUM ASSY, DZH-0B6A-R
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
X-3949-910-1 G. ROLLER ASSY

770
772

8-5

Remark

8-1-5. MECHANISM CHASSIS ASSEMBLY (3)


805

815

817

803

M902

816

818

803
814
#3

812

829
828

811

813

825

810

819
820

808
809 not

827

821

826

807

supplied

822

806

804

823
824

M903

803

801

802

not
supplied

#5
Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Part No.

Description

801
802
803
804
805

3-977-437-01
X-3949-364-1
3-977-443-01
3-063-760-01
3-056-952-11

RETAINER, CAM MOTOR


ASSY, REEL DIRECT SELECT (B)
WASHER, STOPPER
WORM-WHEEL H/R
WASHER, STOPPER

Remark

Ref. No.
817
818
819
820
821

3-063-755-01
3-063-768-01
3-063-757-01
3-977-456-03
X-3948-132-2

GEAR, CAM H/R


SLIDER (SL)
GEAR, LOADING (T) H/R
SPRING, TORSION (LOAD T)
LEVER ASSY, LOADING (T)

806
807
808
809
810

3-977-444-01
3-977-515-01
3-977-517-01
3-977-519-01
3-977-518-02

GEAR, PINCH TRANSMISSION


GUIDE, FL SLIDER
PLATE, SLIDE, FL
SPRING, TENS. (LIMIT, FL)
PLATE, LIMITTER, FL

822
823
824
825
826

3-977-451-01
3-977-452-01
X-3948-131-1
3-977-489-01
3-977-468-01

GEAR, LOADING (S)


SPRING, TORSION (LOAD S)
LEVER ASSY, LOADING (S)
ARM, TG1 DRIVING
SHAFT, CAPSTAN BRAKE

811
812
813
814
815

3-977-516-01
3-977-877-01
3-977-504-01
X-3949-365-1
3-977-510-01

HOLDER, FL SLIDER
PLATE, RETAINER
GEAR, CLUTCH
GEAR ASSY PULLEY (B)
BELT, RUBBER

827
828
829
M902
M903

3-977-467-02
X-3950-965-1
3-063-823-01
1-698-971-11
X-3947-577-1

SPRING, CAP BRAKE


BRAKE ASSY, CAPSTAN (SL)
SPRING, COMP (LIMITTER LOW K)
MOTOR, DC (CAPSTAN)
MOTOR ASSY, CAM

816

3-056-824-01 WASHER, STOPPER

8-6

Remark

DS-95

JK-201

8-2. ELECTRICAL PARTS LIST


NOTE:
Due to standardization, replacements in the
parts list may be different from the parts specified in the diagrams or the components used
on the set.
-XX and -X mean standardized parts, so they
may have some difference from the original
one.
RESISTORS
All resistors are in ohms.
METAL: Metal-film resistor.
METAL OXIDE: Metal oxide-film resistor.
F: nonflammable

Ref. No.

Part No.

A-6794-810-A DS-95 BOARD, COMPLETE


(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
A-6794-812-A DS-95 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810/SX810/X9)
*********************
(Ref.No. 1,000 Series)

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

< CONNECTOR >


CN450
CN451
CN453

1-770-514-31 CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 5P (SE810/SX810/X9)


1-770-519-31 CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 11P (SE810/SX810/X9)
1-770-514-31 CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 5P
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)

Part No.

When indicating parts by reference


number, please include the board.

Description

Remark

S453

1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (N)


(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)

S454
S455
S456
S457

1-786-097-21
1-786-097-21
1-786-097-21
1-786-097-21

SWITCH, TACT (JOG) (SE810/SX810/X9)


SWITCH, TACT (M)
SWITCH, TACT (X)
SWITCH, TACT (A)

A-6794-811-A JK-201 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810/SX810/X9)


***********************
(Ref.No. 1,000 Series)

< DIODE >


D450

The components identified by


mark 0 or dotted line with mark
0 are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number
specified.

Items marked * are not stocked since they


are seldom required for routine service.
Some delay should be anticipated when ordering these items.
SEMICONDUCTORS
In each case, u: , for example:
uA. . : A. .
uPA. .
: PA. .
uPB. . : PB. . uPC. .
: PC. .
uPD. . : PD. .
CAPACITORS
uF: F
COILS
uH: H
Not all of the parts for POWER BLOCK
(SRV938EK) are listed.

< CAPACITOR >

8-719-056-06 DIODE SLR-342DCT31 (JOG)


(SE810/SX810/X9)

C481
C491
C493

1-163-009-11 CERAMIC CHIP


1-163-009-11 CERAMIC CHIP
1-163-009-11 CERAMIC CHIP

0.001uF
0.001uF
0.001uF

10%
10%
10%

50V
50V
50V

5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/16W
1/16W

< SHORT >


< DIODE >
JS450

1-216-295-11 SHORT

0
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)

< TRANSISTOR >


Q450

8-729-043-29 TRANSISTOR

PDTC144EK-115
(SE810/SX810/X9)

< RESISTOR >


1-249-408-11 CARBON

180

R451
R452
R453
R454

1-216-057-00
1-249-417-11
1-216-053-00
1-216-057-00

METAL CHIP
CARBON
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

2.2K
1K
1.5K
2.2K

R455
R456
R457
R458

1-216-061-00
1-249-425-11
1-249-417-11
1-216-053-00

METAL CHIP
CARBON
CARBON
METAL CHIP

3.3K
4.7K
1K
1.5K

5%
1/4W F
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
1/10W
5%
1/4W F
5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/4W F
1/4W F
1/10W

< SWITCH >

S450
S451
S452

1-418-156-11 ENCODER, ROTARYRY (DIAL TIMER)


(SE810/SX810/X9)
1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (z)
1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (m)
1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (x)
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)

8-7

8-719-070-59
8-719-067-40
8-719-067-40
8-719-067-40

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

PDZ6.8B-115
STZ6.8N-T146
STZ6.8N-T146
STZ6.8N-T146

< JACK >


J481

R450

S410

D480
D481
D490
D491

1-695-865-11 JACK, PIN 3P (LINE-2 IN)


< RESISTOR >

R480
R490
R491

1-216-022-00 METAL CHIP


1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP

75
470
470

MA-400
Ref. No.

Part No.

A-6713-793-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE


(SE710D/SX710D/SX717D)
A-6713-794-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE710B/SX710B)
A-6713-795-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810B)
A-6713-796-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810D/SX810)
A-6713-797-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810G)

*
*
*
*

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

*
*
*

A-6713-798-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE710G)


A-6713-799-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE710E/SX710E/SX717E)
A-6713-800-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE710I)
A-6713-801-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810E)
A-6713-802-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610G)

*
*
*
*
*

A-6713-803-A
A-6713-804-A
A-6713-805-A
A-6713-806-A
A-6713-807-A

MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610A)


MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610B)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610E)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9G)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9D)

*
*
*
*
*

A-6713-808-A
A-6713-809-A
A-6713-810-A
A-6713-811-A
A-6713-812-A

MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9B)


MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (X9E)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810N/X9N)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE810K)
MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE
(SE710N/SX710N)

A-6713-813-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE

*
*

(SE710K/SX710K)
A-6713-814-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610N)
A-6713-815-A MA-400 BOARD, COMPLETE (SE610K)
***********************
(Ref.No. 1,000 Series)

*
*

3-057-806-01 BASE, FL
3-058-480-02 HOLDER, FLO
3-960-273-11 SPACER, TOP END
< CAPACITOR >
C100
C101
C102
C103
C105

1-163-009-11
1-163-009-11
1-163-009-11
1-128-057-11
1-163-009-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

0.001uF
0.001uF
0.001uF
330uF
0.001uF

10%
10%
10%
20%
10%

50V
50V
50V
6.3V
50V

C107
C108
C113
C114
C115

1-104-664-11
1-127-573-11
1-162-970-11
1-162-970-11
1-163-038-11

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

47uF
1uF
0.01uF
0.01uF
0.1uF

20%
10%
10%
10%

16V
16V
25V
25V
25V

C120
C121
C122
C123
C131

1-162-970-11
1-162-970-11
1-124-589-11
1-162-970-11
1-124-589-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

0.01uF
0.01uF
47uF
0.01uF
47uF

10%
10%
20%
10%
20%

25V
25V
16V
25V
16V

C133
C134
C140
C141
C142

1-107-826-11
1-107-826-11
1-126-933-11
1-162-970-11
1-163-037-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.1uF
0.1uF
100uF
0.01uF
0.022uF

10%
10%
20%
10%
10%

16V
16V
16V
25V
25V

C143
C144
C145
C146
C147

1-126-965-11
1-126-965-11
1-126-933-11
1-164-161-11
1-107-826-11

ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

22uF
22uF
100uF
0.0022uF
0.1uF

20%
50V
20%
50V
20%
16V
10%
100V
10%
16V
(SE810/SX810/X9)

8-8

Part No.

Description

C160
C161
C162
C163
C164

1-162-970-11
1-162-970-11
1-104-905-11
1-162-970-11
1-126-933-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CAPACITOR
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

0.01uF
0.01uF
0.22F
0.01uF
100uF

Remark

10%
20%

25V
25V
5.5V
25V
16V

C165
C166
C167
C168
C169

1-162-970-11
1-162-970-11
1-163-809-11
1-163-231-11
1-163-237-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.01uF
0.01uF
0.047uF
15PF
27PF

10%
10%
10%
5%
5%

25V
25V
25V
50V
50V

C170
C171
C172
C173
C174

1-107-826-11
1-163-229-11
1-163-227-11
1-163-007-11
1-107-826-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.1uF
12PF
10PF
680PF
0.1uF

10%
5%
0.5PF
10%
10%

16V
50V
50V
50V
16V

C201
C202
C203
C204
C205

1-126-965-11
1-163-809-11
1-163-037-11
1-126-960-11
1-107-826-11

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

22uF
0.047uF
0.022uF
1uF
0.1uF

20%
10%
10%
20%
10%

50V
25V
25V
50V
16V

C206
C207
C209
C210
C211

1-104-664-11 ELECT
47uF
20%
16V
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-163-037-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.022uF 10%
25V
1-126-960-11 ELECT
1uF
20%
50V
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V

C212
C213
C214
C215
C217

1-162-970-11
1-126-960-11
1-162-970-11
1-124-589-11
1-107-826-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

0.01uF
1uF
0.01uF
47uF
0.1uF

10%
20%
10%
20%
10%

25V
50V
25V
16V
16V

C218
C219
C220
C221
C222

1-162-970-11
1-126-960-11
1-124-261-00
1-107-826-11
1-126-160-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

0.01uF
1uF
10uF
0.1uF
1uF

10%
20%
20%
10%
20%

25V
50V
50V
16V
50V

C223
C224
C225
C226
C227

1-107-826-11
1-162-970-11
1-104-664-11
1-107-823-11
1-126-964-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

0.1uF
0.01uF
47uF
0.47uF
10uF

10%
10%
20%
10%
20%

16V
25V
16V
16V
50V

C228
C229
C230
C231
C232

1-109-982-11
1-126-964-11
1-107-826-11
1-107-826-11
1-107-826-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

1uF
10uF
0.1uF
0.1uF
0.1uF

10%
20%
10%
10%
10%

10V
50V
16V
16V
16V

C233
C234
C236
C237
C238

1-104-664-11
1-163-255-11
1-163-259-91
1-126-960-11
1-163-237-11

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

47uF
150PF
220PF
1uF
27PF

20%
5%
5%
20%
5%

16V
50V
50V
50V
50V

C239
C240
C241
C242
C243

1-107-826-11
1-162-970-11
1-126-960-11
1-126-960-11
1-107-826-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

0.1uF
0.01uF
1uF
1uF
0.1uF

C244

1-107-826-11 CERAMIC CHIP

10%
10%

10%
16V
10%
25V
20%
50V
20%
50V
10%
16V
(SE810/SX810/X9)

0.1uF
10%
16V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

MA-400
Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

C245
C247
C248
C249

1-163-989-11
1-104-664-11
1-124-589-11
1-163-243-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

Remark

C250

1-163-243-11 CERAMIC CHIP

C251

1-163-243-11 CERAMIC CHIP

C252
C281
C282

1-163-243-11 CERAMIC CHIP


1-164-489-11 CERAMIC CHIP
1-163-037-11 CERAMIC CHIP

5%
50V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
47PF
5%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
47PF
5%
50V
0.22uF
10%
16V
0.022uF 10%
25V

C284
C285
C286
C288
C293

1-162-970-11
1-124-589-11
1-107-826-11
1-162-970-11
1-163-251-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.01uF
47uF
0.1uF
0.01uF
100PF

10%
20%
10%
10%
5%

25V
16V
16V
25V
50V

C295
C296
C297
C298
C299

1-162-970-11
1-163-227-11
1-163-227-11
1-163-227-11
1-163-227-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.01uF
10PF
10PF
10PF
10PF

10%
0.5PF
0.5PF
0.5PF
0.5PF

25V
50V
50V
50V
50V

C303
C304
C306
C307
C308

1-163-038-11
1-162-970-11
1-104-664-11
1-104-664-11
1-126-964-11

CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT

0.1uF
0.01uF
47uF
47uF
10uF

10%
20%
20%
20%

25V
25V
16V
16V
50V

C309
C310
C311
C312
C313

1-163-020-00
1-119-799-11
1-126-964-11
1-124-257-00
1-126-964-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT

0.0082uF
47uF
10uF
2.2uF
10uF

10%
20%
20%
20%
20%

50V
16V
50V
50V
50V

C314
C315
C316
C317
C319

1-119-799-11
1-163-020-00
1-126-964-11
1-164-489-11
1-124-261-00

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

47uF
0.0082uF
10uF
0.22uF
10uF

20%
10%
20%
10%
20%

16V
50V
50V
16V
50V

C320
C322
C323
C324
C325

1-126-964-11
1-126-964-11
1-163-038-11
1-162-970-11
1-164-489-11

ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

10uF
10uF
0.1uF
0.01uF
0.22uF

20%
20%

50V
50V
25V
25V
16V

C326
C327
C328

1-164-489-11 CERAMIC CHIP


1-164-489-11 CERAMIC CHIP
1-126-960-11 ELECT

0.22uF
0.22uF
1uF

C329

1-126-960-11 ELECT

1uF

C330

1-126-960-11 ELECT

1uF

C331
C332

1-126-960-11 ELECT
1-126-960-11 ELECT

C333

1-126-960-11 ELECT

C336
C337

1-126-964-11 ELECT
1-124-261-00 ELECT

0.033uF
47uF
47uF
47PF

10%
20%
20%
5%

Ref. No.

25V
16V
16V
50V

47PF

10%
10%

10%
16V
10%
16V
20%
50V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
20%
50V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
20%
50V

1uF
20%
50V
1uF
20%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1uF
20%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
10uF
20%
50V
10uF
20%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)

8-9

Part No.

Description

Remark

C338

1-124-261-00 ELECT

C351
C352
C353
C354

1-126-965-11
1-126-963-11
1-162-970-11
1-162-970-11

10uF
20%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
ELECT
22uF
20%
50V
ELECT
4.7uF
20%
50V
CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V

C355
C357
C358
C359

1-124-589-11
1-124-589-11
1-107-826-11
1-137-374-11

ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
MYLAR

C359

1-137-462-11 MYLAR

C361
C362
C363
C365
C366

1-126-163-11
1-128-131-11
1-124-242-00
1-163-010-11
1-163-011-11

ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

4.7uF
22uF
33uF
0.0012uF
0.0015uF

20%
20%
20%
10%
10%

50V
50V
25V
50V
50V

C367
C368
C369
C370
C374

1-162-970-11
1-126-964-11
1-126-960-11
1-124-589-11
1-107-826-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

0.01uF
10uF
1uF
47uF
0.1uF

10%
20%
20%
20%
10%

25V
50V
50V
16V
16V

C375
C390

1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP


1-137-397-11 MYLAR

C391

1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP

C392

1-163-011-11 CERAMIC CHIP

C393

1-126-933-11 ELECT

C394

1-163-251-11 CERAMIC CHIP

100PF

C395
C420
C423
C424

1-107-826-11
1-124-589-11
1-162-970-11
1-124-261-00

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

0.1uF
47uF
0.01uF
10uF

C427
C500
C501
C502
C503

1-124-635-00
1-163-131-00
1-163-131-00
1-163-131-00
1-163-131-00

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

220uF
390PF
390PF
390PF
390PF

C510
C511
C512
C513
C514

1-162-970-11
1-104-664-11
1-104-664-11
1-126-935-11
1-163-239-11

CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF


10%
25V
ELECT
47uF
20%
16V
ELECT
47uF
20%
16V
ELECT
470uF
20%
6.3V
CERAMIC CHIP 33PF
5%
50V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

C515

1-163-239-11 CERAMIC CHIP 33PF


5%
50V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-163-017-00 CERAMIC CHIP 0.0047uF 5%
50V
1-163-131-00 CERAMIC CHIP 390PF
5%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-163-131-00 CERAMIC CHIP 390PF
5%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-163-131-00 CERAMIC CHIP 390PF
5%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)

C516
C570
C571

C572

47uF
20%
16V
47uF
20%
16V
0.1uF
10%
16V
0.047uF 5%
50V
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
0.018uF 5%
100V
(SE810/SX810/X9)

0.01uF
0.047uF

10%
25V
5%
100V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
0.0015uF 10%
50V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
100uF
20%
16V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
50V
(SE810/SX810/X9)
10%
16V
20%
16V
10%
25V
20%
50V
20%
5%
5%
5%
5%

6.3V
50V
50V
50V
50V

MA-400
Ref. No.
C573

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

C874

1-163-038-11 CERAMIC CHIP

0.1uF

C875

1-126-935-11 ELECT

470uF

C580
C611
C612
C613

1-163-131-00 CERAMIC CHIP 390PF


5%
50V
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-127-876-21 CERAMIC
0.01uF
10%
50V
1-104-664-11 ELECT
47uF
20%
25V
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
1-126-933-11 ELECT
100uF
20%
16V

C970

1-163-259-91

C971

1-124-257-00

C618
C621

1-126-965-11 ELECT
1-124-635-00 ELECT

C972

1-163-017-00

C973

1-162-970-11

C974

1-126-160-11 ELECT

C975

1-163-037-11

C976

1-163-259-91

C977

1-162-970-11

C978

1-163-017-00

1-163-255-11 CERAMIC CHIP 150PF


5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-107-826-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.1uF
10%
16V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-163-007-11 CERAMIC CHIP 680PF
10%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-163-009-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.001uF 10%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

22uF
20%
50V
220uF
20%
6.3V
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
15PF
5%
50V
15PF
5%
50V
0.0047uF 5%
50V

C660
C661
C662

1-163-231-11 CERAMIC CHIP


1-163-231-11 CERAMIC CHIP
1-163-017-00 CERAMIC CHIP

C663
C664
C665

C666
C667

1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF


10%
25V
1-107-826-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.1uF
10%
16V
1-163-245-11 CERAMIC CHIP 56PF
5%
50V
(SE610: B, K, N/SE710: B, K, N/SE810: B, K, N/
SX710: B, K, N/X9: B, N)
1-163-135-00 CERAMIC CHIP 560PF
5%
50V
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V

C668
C669
C670
C671
C672

1-125-972-91
1-163-016-00
1-109-982-11
1-163-235-11
1-162-970-11

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

100uF
0.0039uF
1uF
22PF
0.01uF

20%
10%
10%
5%
10%

16V
50V
10V
50V
25V

C979

C701
C702
C704
C705
C708

1-126-964-11
1-164-161-11
1-126-964-11
1-163-021-91
1-104-664-11

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

10uF
0.0022uF
10uF
0.01uF
47uF

20%
10%
20%
10%
20%

50V
100V
50V
50V
16V

C982

C709
C710
C711
C712
C713

1-162-970-11
1-126-965-11
1-104-664-11
1-163-241-11
1-163-241-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.01uF
22uF
47uF
39PF
39PF

10%
20%
20%
5%
5%

25V
50V
16V
50V
50V

C714
C720
C730
C731
C752

1-104-664-11
1-163-021-91
1-126-964-11
1-126-964-11
1-126-933-11

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT

47uF
0.01uF
10uF
10uF
100uF

20%
10%
20%
20%
20%

16V
50V
50V
50V
16V

C753
C754
C755
C757
C801

1-107-826-11
1-126-935-11
1-107-826-11
1-162-970-11
1-162-970-11

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

0.1uF
470uF
0.1uF
0.01uF
0.01uF

10%
20%
10%
10%
10%

16V
6.3V
16V
25V
25V

C850
C851

1-163-038-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.1uF


25V
1-126-964-11 ELECT
10uF
20%
50V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-164-161-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.0022uF 10%
100V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-163-989-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.033uF 10%
25V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-164-489-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.22uF
10%
16V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

C980
C981

C983

C984
C985
C986
C987

C852
C853
C855

C856
C871
C872
C873

C988

C991
C992
C993
C994

1-163-038-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.1uF


25V
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
1-104-664-11 ELECT
47uF
20%
16V
(X9: B, D, E, G)
1-163-038-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.1uF
25V
(X9: B, D, E, G)

C995

C996

25V
(X9: B, D, E, G)

20%
6.3V
(X9: B, D, E, G)
CERAMIC CHIP 220PF
5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
ELECT
2.2uF
20%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
CERAMIC CHIP 0.0047uF 5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1uF
20%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
CERAMIC CHIP 0.022uF 10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
CERAMIC CHIP 220PF
5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
CERAMIC CHIP 0.0047uF 5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF


10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-163-251-11 CERAMIC CHIP 100PF
5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-124-261-00 ELECT
10uF
20%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-124-465-00 ELECT
0.47uF
20%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-163-251-11 CERAMIC CHIP 100PF
5%
50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-107-826-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.1uF
10%
16V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-162-970-11 CERAMIC CHIP 0.01uF
10%
25V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-125-972-91 ELECT
100uF
20%
16V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-163-227-11 CERAMIC CHIP 10PF
0.5PF 50V
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
< CONNECTOR >

CN101
CN102
* CN104
* CN161
CN260

1-784-484-11
1-779-723-11
1-766-716-11
1-506-469-11
1-784-490-11

* CN262
CN350
CN460

1-560-894-00 PIN, CONNECTOR 6P


1-784-486-11 CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 7P
1-784-490-11 CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 11P (SE810/SX810/X9)

8-10

CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 5P
CONNECTOR, BOARD TO BOARD 9P
CONNECTOR, BOARD TO BOARD 3P
PIN, CONNECTOR 4P
CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 11P

MA-400
Ref. No.
CN461
CN500

* CN501
CN570

CN570

CN600
CN601

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

1-784-484-11 CONNECTOR, FFC/FPC 5P


(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
1-793-918-11 CONNECTOR, SQUARE TYPE 21P
(LINE-1 (TV)) (SE610: A, G, K, N)
1-568-954-11 PIN, CONNECTOR 5P (SE810/SX810/X9)
1-793-917-11 CONNECTOR, SQUARE TYPE 21P
(LINE-1 (TV), DECODER/LINE-2 IN)
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SX710/SX717)
1-793-917-11 CONNECTOR, SQUARE TYPE 21P
(LINE-1 (TV), DECODER/LINE-3 IN)
(SE810/SX810/X9)
1-778-674-21 CONNECTOR, BOARD TO BOARD 19P
1-793-673-11 CONNECTOR, BOARD TO BOARD 7P

IC351
IC420
IC460
0 IC601
IC850
IC970

J500
J871

8-719-048-26
8-719-200-82
8-719-067-40
8-719-071-50
8-719-071-50

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

D502
D503
D504
D570

8-719-070-59
8-719-977-40
8-719-070-59
8-719-071-50

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

D571

D572

GL528V1 (T/S LED)


MPG06D-6052PKG3
STZ6.8N-T146
BZA408B-115
BZA408B-115

PDZ6.8B-115
UDZ-TE-17-13B
PDZ6.8B-115
BZA408B-115
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-719-070-59 DIODE PDZ6.8B-115
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

D606
D607
D702
D720
D721
D750

8-719-200-82
8-719-982-26
8-719-911-19
8-719-911-19
8-719-200-82

D800

8-719-911-19 DIODE 1SS119-25TD


(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-719-070-59 DIODE PDZ6.8B-115 (X9)
8-719-070-59 DIODE PDZ6.8B-115 (X9)
8-719-070-59 DIODE PDZ6.8B-115 (X9)

D871
D872
D873

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

MPG06D-6052PKG3
MTZJ-T-77-33
1SS119-25TD
1SS119-25TD
MPG06D-6052PKG3

< IC >
IC130
IC160
IC161
IC161

IC162
IC162
IC201
IC301

8-759-645-07
8-759-248-87
8-759-682-41
8-759-714-06

Remark

8-759-830-96 IC SFH5110-40
8-759-438-18 IC PQ12RD08
8-759-484-61 IC SDA5650X-GEG
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-759-438-17 IC LA7337
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

1-784-414-11 JACK, PIN 2P (LINE-2 OUT)


(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-779-013-11 JACK, MINIATURE (STB CONTROL)
(X9: B, D, E, G)
< JUMPER RESISTOR >

8-719-977-40 DIODE UDZ-TE-17-13B


(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-719-070-59 DIODE PDZ6.8B-115
8-719-911-19 DIODE 1SS119-25TD
8-719-200-82 DIODE MPG06D-6052PKG3
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-719-200-82 DIODE MPG06D-6052PKG3

D573
D590
D603

Description

< JACK >

< DIODE >


D100
D110
D424
D500
D501

Part No.

8-759-499-30 IC BA7755AF-E2
8-759-643-83 IC uPD16315GB-3BS

IC
IC
IC
IC

LB1943N
MM1256XF-BE
M24C32-WMN6T (A) (X9: B, D, E, G)
M24C16-WMN6T (A)
(SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/
SX717/SX810/X9N)
8-759-694-68 IC M37970MGA-051GP (SE610)
8-759-694-69 IC M37970MGA-050GP
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-759-699-51 IC LA71710M-MPB-E
8-759-638-55 IC TDA9605H/N2, 518

8-11

JR001
JR003
JR004
JR006
JR007

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR008
JR009
JR010
JR011
JR012

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR013
JR014
JR015
JR016
JR017

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR018
JR019
JR020
JR021
JR022

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR201
JR202
JR203
JR204
JR205

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR206
JR207
JR208
JR209
JR210

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR211
JR212
JR213
JR214
JR215

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR216
JR217
JR219
JR220
JR221

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR222
JR223

1-216-296-11 SHORT
1-216-296-11 SHORT

0
0
The components identified by mark
0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

MA-400
Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

JR224
JR225
JR226

1-216-296-11 SHORT
1-216-296-11 SHORT
1-216-296-11 SHORT

0
0
0

JR227
JR228
JR229
JR230
JR231

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR232
JR233
JR234
JR235
JR236

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR238
JR239
JR240
JR241
JR242

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR243
JR244
JR245
JR246
JR247

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR248
JR249
JR251
JR252
JR253

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR254
JR255
JR256
JR257
JR258

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR259
JR260
JR261
JR262
JR263

1-216-296-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

JR264
JR265
JR266
JS351
JS591

1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-296-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0 (SE810/SX810/X9)
0

Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

L254

1-414-479-11 INDUCTOR

L255
L281
L301

1-414-479-11 INDUCTOR
1-414-940-21 INDUCTOR
1-414-940-21 INDUCTOR

47nH
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
47nH
100uH
100uH

L351
L352
L353
L355
L356

1-414-940-21
1-414-940-21
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

100uH
100uH
0
0
0

L357
L358
L359
L360
L361

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT

0
0
0
0
0

L362
L390
L460
L510
L660

1-216-295-11
1-410-687-11
1-414-938-21
1-414-940-21
1-414-930-21

SHORT
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR

0
1.2mH (SE810/SX810/X9)
47uH
100uH
2.2uH

L661

1-414-936-21 INDUCTOR
22uH
(SE610: B, K, N/SE710: B, K, N/SE810: B, K, N/
SX710: B, K, N/X9: B, N)
1-414-936-21 INDUCTOR
22uH
1-414-936-21 INDUCTOR
22uH
1-414-930-21 INDUCTOR
2.2uH
1-414-930-21 INDUCTOR
2.2uH

L662
L663
L701
L750
L751
L871
L970
L971
L972

L973
L975

1-414-934-21 INDUCTOR
10uH
1-414-934-21 INDUCTOR
10uH (X9: B, D, E, G)
1-414-933-21 INDUCTOR
6.8uH
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-414-945-21 INDUCTOR
27uH
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-414-938-21 INDUCTOR
47uH
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-414-938-21 INDUCTOR
47uH
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-414-934-21 INDUCTOR
10uH
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
< FLUORESCENT INDICATOR >

ND420

1-518-741-11 TUBE, FLUORESCENT INDICATOR


< PHOTO INTERRUPTER >

< COIL >


L140
L160
L161
L201
L202

1-414-936-21
1-414-936-21
1-414-936-21
1-414-934-21
1-414-934-21

INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR

22uH
22uH
22uH
10uH
10uH

L203
L204
L205
L251
L252

1-414-934-21
1-414-934-21
1-414-940-21
1-414-479-11
1-414-479-11

INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR
INDUCTOR

10uH
10uH
100uH
47nH
47nH

L253

1-414-479-11 INDUCTOR

PH100
PH101

8-749-015-86 PHOTO INTERRUPTER GP3S120S


8-749-015-86 PHOTO INTERRUPTER GP3S120S
< IC LINK >

0 PS120
0 PS390
0 PS602

1-532-605-00 LINK, IC (0.4A)


1-532-727-11 LINK, IC (0.25A) (SE810/SX810/X9)
1-532-727-11 LINK, IC (0.25A) (SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
< TRANSISTOR >

Q100
Q101
Q102

47nH (SE810/SX810/X9)

8-12

8-729-043-84 TRANSISTOR
8-729-043-84 TRANSISTOR
8-729-281-53 TRANSISTOR

PT380F3
PT380F3
2SC1815GR-TPE2

The components identified by mark


0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

MA-400
Ref. No.
Q140
Q201

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR

2PD601AR-115
(SE810/SX810/X9)
8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

Q973
Q974
Q975

Q202
Q351
Q352
Q390

8-729-216-22
8-729-821-15
8-729-281-53
8-729-900-51

TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR

Q391

8-729-043-29 TRANSISTOR

Q392

8-729-012-31 TRANSISTOR

Q501
Q502
Q510
Q540

8-729-043-32
8-729-043-29
8-729-216-22
8-729-216-22

Q541

Q590
Q591
Q592
Q607

2PB709AR-115
2SD1620-TD
2SC1815GR-TPE2
UN2115-QRS (TX)
(SE810/SX810/X9)
PDTC144EK-115
(SE810/SX810/X9)

2SC4040-TL2-Q
(SE810/SX810/X9)
TRANSISTOR
PDTA114EK-115
TRANSISTOR
PDTC144EK-115
TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N
/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)

8-729-216-22 TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/SX710/SX717/
SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
8-729-216-22 TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
8-729-804-41 TRANSISTOR
2SB1122-ST-TD
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

Q608

8-729-043-29 TRANSISTOR

PDTC144EK-115
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
2SB1122-ST-TD
PDTC144EK-115
2PB709AR-115
2PB709AR-115

Q612
Q613
Q660
Q661

8-729-804-41
8-729-043-29
8-729-216-22
8-729-216-22

TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR

Q720
Q721
Q751
Q752
Q800

8-729-119-76
8-729-043-29
8-729-043-29
8-729-216-22
8-729-216-22

TRANSISTOR
2SA1309A-QRSTA
TRANSISTOR
PDTC144EK-115
TRANSISTOR
PDTC144EK-115
TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

Q801

8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-729-043-29 TRANSISTOR
PDTC144EK-115
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
8-729-216-22 TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

Q976
Q977

Q803
Q804
Q850

2PD601AR-115
(X9: B, D, E, G)
TRANSISTOR
2SD999-T1CL
(X9: B, D, E, G)
TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(X9: B, D, E, G)
TRANSISTOR
2PB709AR-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
TRANSISTOR
PDTA114EK-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

Remark

R100
R101
R102
R103
R104

1-216-077-91
1-249-413-11
1-216-077-91
1-216-081-00
1-216-821-11

RES-CHIP
CARBON
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

15K
470
15K
22K
1K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/4W F
1/10W
1/10W
1/16W

R105
R106
R107
R108
R114

1-216-057-00
1-249-400-11
1-249-400-11
1-216-081-00
1-216-089-11

METAL CHIP
CARBON
CARBON
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP

2.2K
39
39
22K
47K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/4W F
1/4W F
1/10W
1/10W

R115
R120
R121
R123
R124

1-216-089-11
1-216-089-11
1-216-089-11
1-249-425-11
1-249-413-11

RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
CARBON
CARBON

47K
47K
47K
4.7K
470

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/4W F
1/4W F

R130
R132
R133
R140

1-216-077-91
1-216-817-11
1-216-089-11
1-216-833-11

RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP

15K
470
47K
10K

R141

1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP

10K

R142
R143
R145
R146
R160

1-216-051-00
1-216-065-91
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-053-00

R160

1-216-061-00 METAL CHIP


3.3K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-067-00 METAL CHIP
5.6K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: K, N/SE710: K, N/SE810: K, N/SX710: K, N/X9N)
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0
(SE610: A, E/SE710: D, E/SE810: D, E/
SX710: D, E/SX717/SX810/X9: D, E)
1-216-053-00 METAL CHIP
1.5K
5%
1/10W
(SE610E/SE710: B, G/SX710B)
1-216-061-00 METAL CHIP
3.3K
5%
1/10W
(SE610N/SE710: E, I/SE810B/SX710E/SX717E)

R160

R161
R161

R161

Q871

8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR

R161

Q872

8-729-140-75

R161

Q873

8-729-422-33

Q970

8-729-216-22

Q972

8-729-043-32

8-13

Description

< RESISTOR >

R160

Q802

Part No.

8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
8-729-422-33 TRANSISTOR
2PD601AR-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
8-729-043-32 TRANSISTOR
PDTA114EK-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
8-729-043-29 TRANSISTOR
PDTC144EK-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
8-729-043-29 TRANSISTOR
PDTC144EK-115
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

R161
R161

R161
R162
R163

5%
1/10W
5%
1/16W
5%
1/10W
5%
1/16W
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
1/16W
(SE810/SX810/X9)

METAL CHIP
1.2K
5%
1/10W
RES-CHIP
4.7K
5%
1/10W
SHORT
0
SHORT
0
METAL CHIP
1.5K
5%
1/10W
(SE610G/SE710: G, I/SE810G/X9G)

1-216-067-00 METAL CHIP


5.6K
5%
1/10W
(SE710N/SE810: E, G/SX710N/X9B)
1-216-071-00 METAL CHIP
8.2K
5%
1/10W
(SE710: D, K/SX710: D, K/SX717D)
1-216-075-00 METAL CHIP
12K
5%
1/10W
(SE810: D, N/SX810/X9: G, N)
1-216-079-00 METAL CHIP
18K
5%
1/10W
(SE810K/X9D)
1-216-085-00 METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE610K/X9E)
1-216-295-11 SHORT
1-249-429-11 CARBON
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP

0 (SE610: A, B, G)
10K
5%
1/4W
10K
5%
1/16W

MA-400
Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

R164
R165

1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP


1-216-061-00 METAL CHIP

10K
3.3K

5%
5%

1/16W
1/10W

R166
R167
R168
R169
R170

1-216-061-00
1-216-069-00
1-216-101-00
1-216-113-00
1-216-061-00

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

3.3K
6.8K
150K
470K
3.3K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R171
R172
R175
R176
R177

1-249-429-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-025-11
1-216-817-11

CARBON
SHORT
SHORT
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP

10K
0
0
100
470

5%

1/4W

5%
5%

1/10W
1/16W

R178
R179
R180
R181
R182

1-216-817-11
1-216-817-11
1-216-069-00
1-216-061-00
1-216-033-00

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

470
470
6.8K
3.3K
220

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/16W
1/16W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R183
R184
R185
R186
R189

1-216-033-00
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-249-417-11

METAL CHIP
SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
CARBON

220
0
0
0
1K

5%

1/10W

5%

1/4W F

R190
R191
R193
R194
R195

1-216-061-00
1-216-061-00
1-249-441-11
1-216-821-11
1-216-295-11

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
CARBON
METAL CHIP
SHORT

3.3K
3.3K
100K
1K
0

5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/4W
1/16W

R196
R200

1-216-061-00 METAL CHIP


3.3K
5%
1/10W
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-055-00 METAL CHIP
1.8K
5%
1/10W
1-216-821-11 METAL CHIP
1K
5%
1/16W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-055-00 METAL CHIP
1.8K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

R201
R202
R203

R204
R205
R206
R207
R208

1-216-071-00
1-216-063-91
1-249-413-11
1-249-413-11
1-216-089-11

METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
CARBON
CARBON
RES-CHIP

8.2K
3.9K
470
470
47K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/4W F
1/4W F
1/10W

R209
R210
R211
R212
R214

1-216-079-00
1-249-429-11
1-216-089-11
1-216-055-00
1-216-069-00

METAL CHIP
CARBON
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

18K
10K
47K
1.8K
6.8K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/4W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R216
R217
R218
R219
R220

1-216-295-11
1-216-059-00
1-216-025-11
1-216-025-11
1-216-025-11

SHORT
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP

R221
R228
R231
R232

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-017-91
1-216-017-91

SHORT
SHORT
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP

R233

1-216-017-91 RES-CHIP

0
2.7K
5%
1/10W
100
5%
1/10W
100
5%
1/10W
100
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
0
0
47
47

5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
(SE810/SX810/X9)
47
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

8-14

Part No.

Description

Remark

R239

1-216-295-11 SHORT

R240

1-216-295-11

R281
R282
R283

1-216-069-00
1-216-059-00
1-216-045-00

0
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
SHORT
0
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
METAL CHIP
6.8K
5%
1/10W
METAL CHIP
2.7K
5%
1/10W
METAL CHIP
680
5%
1/10W

R284
R289
R290
R301
R302

1-216-045-00
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-833-11
1-216-079-00

METAL CHIP
SHORT
SHORT
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

680
0
0
10K
18K

5%

1/10W

5%
5%

1/16W
1/10W

R304
R305
R306
R307
R308

1-216-821-11
1-216-821-11
1-216-083-00
1-216-057-00
1-208-820-11

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

1K
1K
27K
2.2K
39K

5%
5%
5%
5%
0.5%

1/16W
1/16W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R309
R310
R311
R312
R313

1-216-079-00
1-216-079-00
1-216-057-00
1-216-083-00
1-216-133-00

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

18K
18K
2.2K
27K
3.3M

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R315
R316
R322
R323

1-216-033-00
1-216-033-00
1-216-295-11
1-216-065-91

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
SHORT
RES-CHIP

220
220
0
4.7K

5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W

R324

1-216-065-91 RES-CHIP

R325

1-216-079-00 METAL CHIP

R326

1-216-079-00 METAL CHIP

R329
R351
R352

1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP


1-216-017-91 RES-CHIP
1-216-063-91 RES-CHIP

R352

1-216-067-00 METAL CHIP

5.6K

R353
R354
R355
R356

1-217-671-11
1-216-031-00
1-216-075-00
1-216-079-00

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

1
180
12K
18K

R357
R358
R359
R360
R361

1-216-051-00
1-216-079-00
1-216-035-00
1-216-109-00
1-216-833-11

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

1.2K
18K
270
330K
10K

R362
R369
R370
R390

1-216-069-00
1-216-091-00
1-216-047-91
1-216-083-00

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP

6.8K
56K
820
27K

R391

1-249-394-11 CARBON

12

R392

1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP

10K

R420
R421
R422
R423

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-095-00

0
0
0
82K

SHORT
SHORT
SHORT
METAL CHIP

4.7K

5%
1/10W
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
1/10W
(SE810/SX810/X9)

18K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
18K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
470
5%
1/16W
47
5%
1/10W
3.9K
5%
1/10W
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
5%
1/10W
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/16W

5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
5%
1/10W
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
1/4W F
(SE810/SX810/X9)
5%
1/16W
(SE810/SX810/X9)

5%

1/10W

MA-400
Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.
R572

R427
R460
R461
R464
R465

1-216-017-91
1-216-833-11
1-216-037-00
1-216-089-11
1-216-061-00

RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP

47
10K
330
47K
3.3K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/16W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R466
R467
R468
R470
R471

1-216-065-91
1-216-069-00
1-216-077-91
1-216-833-11
1-216-037-00

RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

4.7K
6.8K
15K
10K
330

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/16W
1/10W

R477
R478
R479

1-216-069-00 METAL CHIP


6.8K
5%
1/10W
1-216-077-91 RES-CHIP
15K
5%
1/10W
1-216-089-11 RES-CHIP
47K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W

R573

R574

R575

R500
R501
R502
R503
R509
R510
R511

1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP


470
5%
1/16W
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
1-216-065-91 RES-CHIP
4.7K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-249-408-11 CARBON
180
5%
1/4W F
1-249-407-11 CARBON
150
5%
1/4W F

R512
R514
R515
R516
R517

1-216-021-00
1-216-037-00
1-216-821-11
1-216-065-91
1-216-022-00

R518

1-216-065-91 RES-CHIP
4.7K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-025-11 RES-CHIP
100
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-249-408-11 CARBON
180
5%
1/4W F
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-249-407-11 CARBON
150
5%
1/4W F
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-216-085-00 METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

R541

R542

R543

R545

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP

R546

1-216-089-11 RES-CHIP

R547

1-216-821-11

R548

1-216-022-00

68
330
1K
4.7K
75

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/16W
1/10W
1/10W

47K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
METAL CHIP
1K
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
METAL CHIP
75
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
METAL CHIP
68
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

R549

1-216-021-00

R570

1-216-817-11

R571

1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP

470
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

8-15

Part No.

Description

Remark

1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP

470
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-216-097-11 RES-CHIP
100K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-216-097-11 RES-CHIP
100K
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710: B, D, E, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)

R590
R591
R592
R611

1-216-821-11
1-216-821-11
1-216-821-11
1-216-821-11

R615

1-216-047-91 RES-CHIP

R617
R618
R624
R625
R626

1-216-821-11
1-216-055-00
1-216-833-11
1-216-065-91
1-249-417-11

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
CARBON

1K
1.8K
10K
4.7K
1K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/16W
1/10W
1/16W
1/10W
1/4W F

R627
R660
R661
R662
R663

1-216-121-11
1-216-821-11
1-216-121-11
1-216-817-11
1-216-053-00

RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

1M
1K
1M
470
1.5K

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/16W
1/10W
1/16W
1/10W

R664
R666
R667
R668
R669

1-216-295-11
1-216-295-11
1-216-037-00
1-216-025-11
1-216-025-11

SHORT
SHORT
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP

0
0
330
100
100

5%
5%
5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

R670
R671
R672

R702
R704

1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP


470
5%
1/16W
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0
1-216-821-11 METAL CHIP
1K
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, K, N/SE710: B, K, N/SE810: B, K, N/
SX710: B, K, N/X9: B, N)
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0
1-216-025-11 RES-CHIP
100
5%
1/10W

R705
R713
R714
R723
R724

1-216-033-00
1-216-025-11
1-216-113-00
1-216-025-11
1-216-089-11

R730
R731

R736

1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP


470
5%
1/16W
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
(SE610: A, B, E, K, N/SE710: B, D, E, I, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
(SE610: A, B, E, K, N/SE710: B, D, E, I, K, N/
SE810: B, D, E, K, N/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9: B, D, E, N)
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0

R754

1-216-025-11 RES-CHIP

R732
R733

METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP
METAL CHIP

METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
METAL CHIP
RES-CHIP
RES-CHIP

1K
5%
1/16W
1K
5%
1/16W
1K
5%
1/16W
1K
5%
1/16W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
820
5%
1/10W
(SE610: B, E/SE710/SE810/
SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

220
100
470K
100
47K

100

5%
5%
5%
5%
5%

5%

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W

1/10W

MA-400
Ref. No.
R755
R756
R757
R800

R801
R802
R803
R804
R805

R806
R807
R813
R850
R851

Part No.

Description

1-216-025-11
1-216-833-11
1-216-821-11
1-216-101-00

RES-CHIP
100
5%
1/10W
METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
METAL CHIP
1K
5%
1/16W
METAL CHIP
150K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

Remark

Ref. No.
R973

1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP


10K
5%
1/16W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-081-00 METAL CHIP
22K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

R976

1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP


10K
5%
1/16W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-085-00 METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
1-216-025-11 RES-CHIP
100
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-077-91 RES-CHIP
15K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)

R981

R974
R975

R977

R978
R979
R980

R982

R983
R985
R986

R852
R853
R856
R857
R858

R859
R860
R861
R862
R871

1-216-081-00 METAL CHIP


22K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-821-11 METAL CHIP
1K
5%
1/16W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-097-11 RES-CHIP
100K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-069-00 METAL CHIP
6.8K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-069-00 METAL CHIP
6.8K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-123-11 METAL CHIP
1.2M
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-123-11 METAL CHIP
1.2M
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-117-00 METAL CHIP
680K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-057-00 METAL CHIP
2.2K
5%
1/10W
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
1-216-065-91 RES-CHIP
4.7K
5%
1/10W
(X9: B, D, E, G)

R988
R989

1-216-105-91 RES-CHIP

220K

R873

1-216-057-00 METAL CHIP

2.2K

R874

1-216-821-11 METAL CHIP

1K

R875

1-216-821-11 METAL CHIP

1K

R876

1-216-001-00 METAL CHIP

10

R968

1-216-101-00 METAL CHIP


150K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-069-00 METAL CHIP
6.8K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-085-00 METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-085-00 METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-083-00 METAL CHIP
27K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

R969
R970
R971
R972

5%
1/10W
(X9: B, D, E, G)
5%
1/10W
(X9: B, D, E, G)
5%
1/16W
(X9: B, D, E, G)
5%
1/16W
(X9: B, D, E, G)
5%
1/10W
(X9: B, D, E, G)

8-16

Description

Remark

1-216-071-00 METAL CHIP


8.2K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-097-11 RES-CHIP
100K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-083-00 METAL CHIP
27K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-089-11 RES-CHIP
47K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-067-00 METAL CHIP
5.6K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-817-11 METAL CHIP
470
5%
1/16W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-089-11 RES-CHIP
47K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-077-91 RES-CHIP
15K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-821-11 METAL CHIP
1K
5%
1/16W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

R990

1-216-295-11 SHORT

R993

1-216-085-00

R994

1-208-820-11

R995

1-216-085-00

R996

1-208-820-11

R997

1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP


10K
5%
1/16W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-833-11 METAL CHIP
10K
5%
1/16W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

R998
R999

R872

Part No.

1-216-105-91 RES-CHIP
220K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-081-00 METAL CHIP
22K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-295-11 SHORT
0
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-059-00 METAL CHIP
2.7K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-216-089-11 RES-CHIP
47K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

0
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
METAL CHIP
39K
0.5% 1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
METAL CHIP
33K
5%
1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
METAL CHIP
39K
0.5% 1/10W
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)

< SWITCH >


S100
S101
S460
S463
S464

1-771-155-11
1-571-958-11
1-786-097-21
1-786-097-21
1-786-097-21

SWITCH, ROTARY (CAM ENCODER)


SWITCH, PUSH (1 KEY) (REC PROOF)
SWITCH, TACT (?/1)
SWITCH, TACT (PROGRAM +)
SWITCH, TACT (AUDIO DUB)
(SE810/SX810/X9)

S476
S477
S478

1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (PROGRAM -)


1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (AUTO SET UP/RF CHANNEL)
1-786-097-21 SWITCH, TACT (SYNCHRO REC)
(SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9)
< TRANSFORMER >

T350
T350

1-431-097-11 TRANSFORMER, BIAS OSCILLATION


(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
1-435-728-11 TRANSFORMER, BIAS OSCILLATION
(SE810/SX810/X9)

MA-400
Ref. No.
T390

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

1-423-415-11 TRANSFORMER, BIAS OSCILLATION


(SE810/SX810/X9)

C303

Part No.

POWER BLOCK

Description

1-126-965-91 ELECT

Remark
22uF

50V

< CONNECTOR >


< TUNER >
TU702

TU702
TU702
TU702

TU703

1-693-436-81 TUNER, IF (BTF-3WC428)


(SE610: E, N/SE710 :E, N, I/SE810: E, N/
SX710: E, N/SX717E/X9E)
1-693-437-81 TUNER, IF (BTF-3WU604)
(SE610G/SE710G/SE810G/X9G)
1-693-438-81 TUNER, IF (BTF-3WC446)
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-693-439-81 TUNER, IF (BTF-3WC429)
(SE610: A, K/SE710: D, K/SE810: D, K/
SX710: D, K/SX717D/SX810/X9D)
1-693-521-11 TUNER, IF (BTF-2WC421)
(SE610: E, N/SE710 :E, N, I/SE810: E, N/
SX710: E, N/SX717E/X9E)

0 CN101
CN201
CN202

< DIODE >


0 D101
0 D102
0 D103
0 D104
D151

9-880-927-01
9-880-927-01
9-880-927-01
9-880-927-01
8-719-084-75

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

1N4005
1N4005
1N4005
1N4005
P6KE300 ARL

D152
D153
D154
D158
D203

9-885-001-78
9-885-001-79
9-885-001-80
9-880-991-01
9-885-001-86

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

UF4007
1SS119
PR1003
MA4270
MTZJ5.1

D204
D205
D251
D252
D253

9-885-001-79
9-885-001-79
9-885-001-80
9-885-001-87
9-885-001-88

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

1SS119
1SS119
PR1003
UF3DL
SB340L

D254
D301
D302
D303
D304

9-885-001-80
9-885-001-87
9-885-001-89
9-885-001-90
9-885-001-89

DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE
DIODE

PR1003
UF3DL
D2S4M
MTZJ20
D2S4M

250V
250V
250V

D307

9-885-001-89 DIODE D2S4M

< VIBRATOR >


X160
X161
X200

1-579-463-11 VIBRATOR, CRYSTAL (32.768kHz)


1-781-717-21 VIBRATOR, CRYSTAL (17.734475MHz)
1-579-608-21 VIBRATOR, CRYSTAL (4.433619MHz)

1-468-458-14 POWER BLOCK (SRV938EK)


***********************
(Ref.No. 2,000 Series)

1-580-230-11 CONNECTOR
1-778-675-21 CONNECTOR 19P
1-793-674-21 CONNECTOR 7P

< CAPACITOR >


0 C101
0 C102
0 C103
0 C104
0 C105

9-885-001-69
9-885-001-69
9-885-001-70
9-885-001-70
9-885-001-70

METAL
METAL
CERAMIC
CERAMIC
CERAMIC

0.1uF
0.1uF
1000PF
1000PF
1000PF

0 C108
0 C109
0 C151
C153
C155

1-113-937-91
1-113-937-91
9-885-001-81
1-163-015-91
1-126-965-91

CERAMIC
CERAMIC
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT

2200PF
2200PF
47uF
3300PF
22uF

250V
250V
400V

0 F101

50V

0 IC151
IC251

C156
C157
C158
C159
C160

1-126-960-91
1-163-009-91
1-163-273-91
1-163-251-91
1-163-021-91

ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP
CERAMIC CHIP

1uF
1000PF
820PF
100PF
10000PF

50V

C161
C201
C202
C203
C206

1-163-009-91
9-885-001-91
1-126-925-91
1-126-934-91
1-126-947-91

CERAMIC CHIP
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT

1000PF
220uF
470uF
220uF
47uF

25V
10V
16V
35V

C207
C208
C209
C212
C213

1-126-964-91
1-126-925-91
1-163-021-91
1-163-021-91
1-126-956-91

ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC
CERAMIC
ELECT

10uF
470uF
0.01uF
0.01uF
0.1uF

50V
10V
50V
50V
50V

C251
C252
C253
C254
C261

1-126-967-91
1-111-065-11
1-111-016-91
9-885-001-92
1-164-489-91

ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
ELECT
CERAMIC CHIP

47uF
680uF
1200uF
470uF
0.22uF

50V
25V
10V
25V
16V

C301

1-111-118-91 ELECT

220uF

50V

< FUSE >


9-885-001-72 FUSE (T2AL/250V)
< IC >
9-885-001-74 IC TDA16846
9-885-001-82 IC AN1431T
< LINE FILTER/COIL >
0 L101
0 L102
0 L103
L201
L202
L205

9-885-001-67
9-885-001-68
9-885-001-68
9-885-001-93
9-885-001-93

LINE FILTER
LINE FILTER
LINE FILTER
CHOKE COIL
CHOKE COIL

9-885-001-94 CHOKE COIL

10uH
33mH
33mH
10uH
10uH
1uH

< PHOTO COUPLER >


0 PC151

9-885-001-75 COUPLER, PHOTO ON3171


< IC LINK >

0 PS201
0 PS202
0 PS251

1-533-592-21 LINK, IC (1.6A)


1-533-593-21 LINK, IC (2A)
1-533-589-21 LINK, IC (750mA)
< TRANSISTOR >

0 Q151
0 Q201

8-17

9-885-001-73 TRANSISTOR 2SK3047


8-729-141-01 TRANSISTOR 2SB733
The components identified by mark
0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

POWER BLOCK
Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

Q203
Q204
Q205

8-729-030-98 TRANSISTOR 2PD601A


8-729-139-97 TRANSISTOR 2SC2785
8-729-018-99 TRANSISTOR 2SD2394

Q206
Q207
Q210
Q211
Q301

8-729-139-97
9-885-001-83
8-729-043-32
8-729-043-29
8-729-018-99

TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR

2SC2785
2SD1862
DTA114EKA
DTC114EKA
2SD2394

Q302
Q303
Q304
Q305
Q306

9-885-001-84
8-729-018-99
8-729-139-97
8-729-141-01
9-885-001-84

TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR
TRANSISTOR

DTC143EKA
2SD2394
2SC2785
2SB733
DTC143EKA

Q307

9-885-001-85 TRANSISTOR 2SA1015

Ref. No.
R314
R315
R316

Part No.

Description

1-215-892-81 METAL
1-215-892-81 METAL
1-247-879-91 CARBON

Remark
1K
1K
100K

2W
2W
1/4W

< TRANSFORMER >


0 T151

9-885-001-76 TRANSFORMER, POWER


< VARIABLE RESISTOR >

VR251

1-241-629-11 VARIABLE RESISTOR

5K

< VARISTOR >


0 Z101

9-880-928-01 VARISTOR ERZV10D751

MISCELLANEOUS
**************

< RESISTOR >


R101
R151
R152
R155
R156

9-885-001-71
1-247-903-91
1-247-903-91
1-216-073-21
1-259-880-91

CARBON
CARBON
CARBON
RES, CHIP
CARBON

1M
1M
1M
10K
2.2M

1/2W
1/4W
1/4W
1/10W
1/4W

R157
R158
R159
R160
R161

1-259-880-91
1-247-805-91
1-249-397-11
1-247-795-91
1-216-085-21

CARBON
CARBON
CARBON
CARBON
RES, CHIP

2.2M
82
22
33
33K

1/4W
1/4W
1/4WF
1/4W
1/10W

R162
R163
R164
R201
R203

1-216-085-21
1-216-063-21
1-247-861-91
1-216-049-21
1-216-452-21

RES, CHIP
RES, CHIP
CARBON
RES, CHIP
METAL

33K
3.9K
18K
1K
180

1/10W
1/10W
1/4W
1/10W
2W

R206
R207
R208
R209
R210

1-216-053-21
1-247-615-91
1-247-615-91
1-247-615-91
1-216-049-21

RES, CHIP
CARBON
CARBON
CARBON
RES, CHIP

1.5K
220
220
220
1K

1/10W
1/4W
1/4W
1/4W
1/10W

R213
R216
R217
R218
R219

1-216-089-21
1-216-065-21
1-215-857-81
1-215-908-81
1-247-847-91

RES, CHIP
RES, CHIP
METAL
METAL
CARBON

47K
4.7K
10
33
4.7K

1/10W
1/10W
1W
3W
1/4W

R220
R222
R251
R261
R263

1-216-065-21
1-247-615-91
1-249-402-11
1-216-049-21
1-216-079-21

RES, CHIP
CARBON
CARBON
RES, CHIP
RES, CHIP

4.7K
220
56
1K
18K

1/10W
1/4W
1/4W F
1/10W
1/10W

R264
R265
R266
R301
R302

1-216-077-21
1-216-073-21
1-216-061-21
1-216-073-21
1-215-869-81

RES, CHIP
RES, CHIP
RES, CHIP
RES, CHIP
METAL

15K
10K
3.3K
10K
1K

1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1/10W
1W

R306
R307
R308
R311
R312

1-216-073-21
1-215-869-81
1-216-049-21
1-247-885-91
1-215-880-81

RES, CHIP
METAL
RES, CHIP
CARBON
METAL

10K
1K
1K
10K
10

1/10W
1W
1/10W
1/4W
2W

R313

1-215-880-81 METAL

10

2W

4
4
5
53
54
0 55
704
721
770
770

M902
M903

1-757-593-11 CABLE, FLAT (FDS-10)


(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717)
1-757-594-11 CABLE, FLAT (FDS-9) (SE810/SX810/X9)
1-762-844-31 SWITCH, ROTARY (SE810/SX810/X9)
1-757-537-11 CABLE, FLAT (FAC-9)
1-792-022-11 CABLE, FLAT (FFM-001)
1-782-012-11
1-500-471-11
A-6775-791-A
1-772-364-11

CORD, POWER
HEAD, FE
ACE BLOCK ASSY (ALPS) (EURO 3)
DRUM ASSY, DZH-0B5A-R (EXCEPT SE610B/
SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-772-365-11 DRUM ASSY, DZH-0B6A-R
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B/X9B)
1-698-971-11 MOTOR, DC (CAPSTAN)
X-3947-577-1 MOTOR ASSY, CAM

**************
HARDWARE LIST
**************
#1
#3
#4
#5

7-685-648-79
7-685-646-79
7-682-147-01
7-685-133-19

SCREW +BVTP 3X12 TYPE2


SCREW +BVTP 3X8 TYPE2
SCREW +P 3X6
SCREW (DIA. 2.6) (IT3B)

ACCESSORIES & PACKING MATERIALS


********************************
1-418-010-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259)
(SX717/SX810)
1-418-010-31 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259B)
(X9N)
1-418-780-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288)
(SX710: D, E, K, N)
1-418-780-21 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288A)
(SX710B)
1-418-782-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259K)
(SE810: D, E, G, K, N)
1-418-782-21 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259L)
(SE810B)
1-476-070-11 CONTROLLER, STB/SAT (RMT-CM103)
(X9: B, D, E)
1-476-070-21 CONTROLLER, STB/SAT (RMT-CM103) (X9G)

8-18

The components identified by mark


0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

Ref. No.

Part No.

Description

Remark

Ref. No.

1-476-369-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259R)


(X9: D, E, G)
1-476-370-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V259S)
(X9B)

1-476-406-11 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288B)


(SE610: A, E, G, K, N/SE710: D, E, G, I, K, N)
1-476-406-21 COMMANDER, STANDARD (RMT-V288C)
(SE610B/SE710B)
1-770-019-11 ADAPTOR, CONVERSION PLUG 3P
(SE610G/SE710: G, I/SE810G/X9G)
1-790-419-11 CORD, CONNECTION (PAL)
3-065-674-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (FRENCH)
(SE610E/SE710: D, E/SE810: D, E/SX710: D, E/
SX810)

Part No.

Description

Remark

3-067-103-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (FRENCH) (X9B)


3-067-104-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (ENGLISH) (X9G)
3-067-105-11 INSTRUCTION (QUICK START GUIDE) (X9G)
3-068-372-11
3-068-372-21
3-068-372-31
3-068-372-41
3-068-372-51

MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (ENGLISH) (X9N)


MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (CZECH) (X9N)
MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (POLISH) (X9N)
MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (HUNGALIAN) (X9N)
MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (RUSSIAN) (X9N)

3-709-430-01 COVER, REMOTE CONTROL


(for RMT-V259/V288/V288A/V288B/V288C)
(SE610/SE710/SX710/SX717/SX810)
3-709-430-11 COVER, REMOTE CONTROL
(for RMT-V259K/V259L) (SE810)

3-065-674-21 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (SPANISH)


(SE610E/SE710E/SE810E/SX710E/SX717E)
3-065-674-31 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (GERMAN)
(SE610: A, E/SE710: D, E/SE810: D, E/
SX710: D, E/SX717D/SX810)
3-065-674-41 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (ITALIAN)
(SE610A/SE710D/SE810D/SX710D/SX810)
3-065-674-51 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (DUTCH)
(SE610: A, E/SE710: D, E/SE810: D, E/
SX710: D, E/SX810)
3-065-674-61 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (PORTUGUESE)
(SE610E/SE710E/SE810E/SX710E)
3-065-674-71 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (GREEK)
(SE610A/SE710D/SE810D)
3-065-675-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (SWEEDISH)
(SE610E/SE710E/SE810E/SX710E/SX717E)
3-065-675-21 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (DANISH)
(SE610E/SE710E/SE810E/SX710E/SX717E)
3-065-675-31 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (FINNISH)
(SE610E/SE710E/SE810E/SX710E/SX717E)
3-065-676-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (FRENCH)
(SE610B/SE710B/SE810B/SX710B)
3-065-677-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (ENGLISH)
(SE610G/SE710: G, I/SE810G)
3-065-678-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (ENGLISH)
(SE610: K, N/SE710: K, N/SE810: K, N/
SX710: K, N)
3-065-678-21 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (CZECH)
(SE610K/SE710K/SE810K/SX710K)
3-065-678-31 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (POLISH)
(SE610N/SE710N/SE810N/SX710N)
3-065-678-41 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (HUNGALIAN)
(SE610N/SE710N/SE810N/SX710N)
3-065-678-51 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (RUSSIAN)
(SE610K/SE810K)
3-065-680-11 INSTRUCTION (QUICK START GUIDE)
(SE610G/SE710G/SE810G)
3-067-100-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (FRENCH) (X9: D, E)
3-067-100-21 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (SPANISH) (X9E)
3-067-100-31 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (GERMAN) (X9: D, E)
3-067-100-41 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (ITALIAN) (X9D)
3-067-100-51 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (DUTCH) (X9: D, E)
3-067-100-61 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (PORTUGUESE)
(X9E)
3-067-100-71 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (GREEK) (X9D)
3-067-101-11 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (SWEDISH) (X9E)
3-067-101-21 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (DANISH) (X9E)
3-067-101-31 MANUAL, INSTRUCTION (FINNISH) (X9E)

8-19
8-19E

The components identified by mark


0 or dotted line with mark 0 are
critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.

SLV-SE610/SE710/SE810/SX710/SX717/SX810/X9

Sony Corporation
9-921-794-11

Home Video Division Company

120

2001C0500-1
2001. 3
Published by Quality Assurance Dept.

You might also like